blob: 570abab6b636d1ab1d56a402e58e60a6d862a5e7 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaucd069922015-02-01 07:54:32 +01005 version 1.5.11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaucd069922015-02-01 07:54:32 +01007 2015/02/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200500 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100501 - tune.zlib.memlevel
502 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 * Debugging
505 - debug
506 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507
508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005093.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510------------------------------------
511
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200512ca-base <dir>
513 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200514 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
515 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200516
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517chroot <jail dir>
518 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
519 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
520 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
521 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
522 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
523 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100524
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100525cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
526 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
527 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
528 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100529 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
530 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
531 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
532 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
533 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
534 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
535 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
536 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
537 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
538 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100539
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200540crt-base <dir>
541 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
542 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
543 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545daemon
546 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
547 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
548 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
549
550gid <number>
551 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
552 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
553 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100554 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
555 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100557
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200558group <group name>
559 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
560 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100561
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200562log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
564 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100565 configured with "log global".
566
567 <address> can be one of:
568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100569 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100570 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
571 port).
572
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100573 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
574 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
575 port).
576
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100577 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
578 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
579 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
580 writeable).
581
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100582 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
583 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
584 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
585 in Bourne shell.
586
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200587 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
588 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
589 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
590 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
591 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
592 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
593 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
594 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
595 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
596 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
597 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
598
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100599 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600
601 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
602 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
603 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
604
605 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200606 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
607 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
608 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
609 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
610 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
611 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200613 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100615log-send-hostname [<string>]
616 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
617 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
618 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
619 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
620 the logs.
621
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000622log-tag <string>
623 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
624 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
625 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
626 running on the same host.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628nbproc <number>
629 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
630 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
631 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
632 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
633 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
634
635pidfile <pidfile>
636 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
637 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
638 starting the process. See also "daemon".
639
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100640stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200641 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
642 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
643 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
644 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
645 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
646 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100647 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200648 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
649 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200650
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
653 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300654 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100655 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
656 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
657 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
658 "bind" keyword for more information.
659
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100660ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
662 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
663 keyword to see available options.
664
665 Example:
666 global
667 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
668
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100669ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
671 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300672 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100673 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
674 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
675 information.
676
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100677ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
679 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
680 keyword to see available options.
681
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100682ssl-server-verify [none|required]
683 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
684 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
685 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
686
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200687stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
688 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
689 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
690 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
691 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
694 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
695 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200696
697stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
698 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
699 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100700 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200701
702stats maxconn <connections>
703 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
704 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706uid <number>
707 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
708 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
709 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
710 one. See also "gid" and "user".
711
712ulimit-n <number>
713 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
714 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
715 option.
716
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100717unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
718 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
719
720 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
721 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
722 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
723 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
724 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
725 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
726 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
727 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
728 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
729 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731user <user name>
732 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
733 See also "uid" and "group".
734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200735node <name>
736 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
737
738 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
739 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
740 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
741 traffic.
742
743description <text>
744 Add a text that describes the instance.
745
746 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
747 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
748 "<" and ">" characters.
749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007513.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200752-----------------------
753
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200754max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
755 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
756 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
757 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
758 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
759 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
760 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
761 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
762 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200764maxconn <number>
765 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
766 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
767 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200768 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
769 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
770 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
771 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
772 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200774maxconnrate <number>
775 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
776 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
777 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
778 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
779 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
780 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
781 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
782 fairness.
783
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100784maxcomprate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300786 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100787 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
788 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
789 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
790 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
791 default value.
792
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100793maxcompcpuusage <number>
794 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
795 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
796 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
797 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
798 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
799 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
800 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
801 process down and from introducing high latencies.
802
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100803maxpipes <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
805 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
806 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
807 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
808 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
809 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
810
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200811maxsessrate <number>
812 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
813 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
814 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
815 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
816 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
817 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
818 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
819 fairness.
820
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200821maxsslconn <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
823 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
824 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
825 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
826 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
827 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
828 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
829
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200830maxsslrate <number>
831 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
832 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
833 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
834 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
835 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
836 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
837 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
838 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
839 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
840 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
841
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100842maxzlibmem <number>
843 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
844 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
845 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100846 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
847 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
848 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
849
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200850noepoll
851 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
852 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100853 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200854
855nokqueue
856 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
857 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
858 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
859
860nopoll
861 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
862 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100863 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100864 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200865
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100866nosplice
867 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
868 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
869 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100870 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100871 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
872 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
873 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
874 "option splice-response".
875
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300876nogetaddrinfo
877 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
878 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
879
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200880spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900881 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
882 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
883 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
884 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
885 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
886 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200887
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200888tune.bufsize <number>
889 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
890 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
891 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
892 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
893 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
894 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
895 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
896 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400897 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
898 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
899 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200900
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200901tune.chksize <number>
902 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
903 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
904 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
905 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
906 checks whenever possible.
907
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100908tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
909 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
910 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
911 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
912 this value. The default value is 1.
913
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100914tune.http.cookielen <number>
915 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
916 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
917 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
918 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
919 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
920 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
921 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
922 to change this value.
923
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200924tune.http.maxhdr <number>
925 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
926 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
927 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
928 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
929 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
930 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
931 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
932 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
933 limit too high.
934
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100935tune.idletimer <timeout>
936 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
937 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
938 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
939 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
940 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
941 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
942 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
943 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
944 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
945
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100946tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100947 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
948 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
949 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
950 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
951 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
952 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
953 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
954 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
955 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
956 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100957
958tune.maxpollevents <number>
959 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
960 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
961 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
962 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
963 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
964
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200965tune.maxrewrite <number>
966 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
967 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
968 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
969 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
970 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
971 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
972 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
973 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
974 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
975 bufsize.
976
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200977tune.pipesize <number>
978 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
979 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
980 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
981 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
982 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
983 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
984
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100985tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
986tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
987 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
988 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
989 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
990 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
991 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
992 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
993 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
994
995tune.sndbuf.client <number>
996tune.sndbuf.server <number>
997 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
998 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
999 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1000 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1001 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1002 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1003 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1004 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1005 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1006 notifying haproxy again.
1007
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001008tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001009 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1010 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1011 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001012 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001013 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1014 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1015 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1016 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1017 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001018 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1019 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001020
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001021tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1022 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1023 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1024 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1025 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1026 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1027 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1028
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001029tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1030 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001031 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001032 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1033 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1034 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1035 being used for too long.
1036
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001037tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1038 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1039 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1040 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1041 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1042 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1043 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1044 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1045 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1046 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1047 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001048 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1049 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001050
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001051tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1052 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1053 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1054 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1055 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1056 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1057 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1058 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1059 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1060
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001061tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1062 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001063 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001064 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1065 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1066 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1067
1068tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1069 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1070 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1071 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1072 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010743.3. Debugging
1075--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077debug
1078 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1079 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1080 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1081 system startup.
1082
1083quiet
1084 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1085 line argument "-q".
1086
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010883.4. Userlists
1089--------------
1090It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1091http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1092it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1093
1094userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001095 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001096 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1097
1098group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001099 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001100 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1101 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1102
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001103user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1104 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001105 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1106 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001107 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1108 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001109 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001110 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001111
1112
1113 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001114 userlist L1
1115 group G1 users tiger,scott
1116 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001118 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1119 user scott insecure-password elgato
1120 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001121
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001122 userlist L2
1123 group G1
1124 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001125
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001126 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1127 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1128 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001129
1130 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001132
11333.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001134----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1136haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1137pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1138identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1139or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1140Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1141known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1142the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1143process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1144during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1145tables.
1146
1147peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001148 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001149 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1150
1151peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1152 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1153 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1154 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1155 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1156 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1157 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1158
1159 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1160 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1161
1162 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1163 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1164 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1165 across all peers.
1166
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001167 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1168 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1169 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1170
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001171 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001172 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001173 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1174 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1175 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001176
1177 backend mybackend
1178 mode tcp
1179 balance roundrobin
1180 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1181 stick on src
1182
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001183 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1184 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001185
1186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011874. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001188----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001189
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001190Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1191 - defaults <name>
1192 - frontend <name>
1193 - backend <name>
1194 - listen <name>
1195
1196A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1197its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1198section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001199section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001200
1201A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1202connections.
1203
1204A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1205to forward incoming connections.
1206
1207A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1208parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1209
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001210All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1211'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1212case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1213
1214Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1215logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1216proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1217However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1218name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1219
1220Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1221and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001222bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001223protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1224modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1225arbitrary criteria.
1226
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001227In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1228a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1229the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1230
1231 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1232 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1233 between responses and new requests.
1234
1235 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1236 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1237 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1238 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1239
1240 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1241 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1242 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1243
1244 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1245 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1246 client-facing connection remains open.
1247
1248 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1249 after the end of the response.
1250
1251The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1252frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1253following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1254weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1255
1256 Backend mode
1257
1258 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1259 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1260 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1261 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1262 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1263 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1264 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1265 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1266 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1267 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1268 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001270
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012724.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1273--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001275The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1276limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1277they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1278limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001279marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001280option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001281and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1282with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1283specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001284
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001285
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1287------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1288acl - X X X
1289appsession - - X X
1290backlog X X X -
1291balance X - X X
1292bind - X X -
1293bind-process X X X X
1294block - X X X
1295capture cookie - X X -
1296capture request header - X X -
1297capture response header - X X -
1298clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001299compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001300contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1301cookie X - X X
1302default-server X - X X
1303default_backend X X X -
1304description - X X X
1305disabled X X X X
1306dispatch - - X X
1307enabled X X X X
1308errorfile X X X X
1309errorloc X X X X
1310errorloc302 X X X X
1311-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1312errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001313force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001314fullconn X - X X
1315grace X X X X
1316hash-type X - X X
1317http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001318http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001319http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001320http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001321http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001322http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001323id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001324ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001325log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001326log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001327max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001328maxconn X X X -
1329mode X X X X
1330monitor fail - X X -
1331monitor-net X X X -
1332monitor-uri X X X -
1333option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1334option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1335option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1336option allbackups (*) X - X X
1337option checkcache (*) X - X X
1338option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1339option contstats (*) X X X -
1340option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1341option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1342option forceclose (*) X X X X
1343-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1344option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001345option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001346option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001347option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001348option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001349option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001350option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1351option httpchk X - X X
1352option httpclose (*) X X X X
1353option httplog X X X X
1354option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001355option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001356option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001357option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1358option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1359option logasap (*) X X X -
1360option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001361option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001362option nolinger (*) X X X X
1363option originalto X X X X
1364option persist (*) X - X X
1365option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001366option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001367option smtpchk X - X X
1368option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1369option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1370option splice-request (*) X X X X
1371option splice-response (*) X X X X
1372option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1373option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1374-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001375option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001376option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1377option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1378option tcpka X X X X
1379option tcplog X X X X
1380option transparent (*) X - X X
1381persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1382rate-limit sessions X X X -
1383redirect - X X X
1384redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1385redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1386reqadd - X X X
1387reqallow - X X X
1388reqdel - X X X
1389reqdeny - X X X
1390reqiallow - X X X
1391reqidel - X X X
1392reqideny - X X X
1393reqipass - X X X
1394reqirep - X X X
1395reqisetbe - X X X
1396reqitarpit - X X X
1397reqpass - X X X
1398reqrep - X X X
1399-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1400reqsetbe - X X X
1401reqtarpit - X X X
1402retries X - X X
1403rspadd - X X X
1404rspdel - X X X
1405rspdeny - X X X
1406rspidel - X X X
1407rspideny - X X X
1408rspirep - X X X
1409rsprep - X X X
1410server - - X X
1411source X - X X
1412srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001413stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001414stats auth X - X X
1415stats enable X - X X
1416stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001417stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001418stats realm X - X X
1419stats refresh X - X X
1420stats scope X - X X
1421stats show-desc X - X X
1422stats show-legends X - X X
1423stats show-node X - X X
1424stats uri X - X X
1425-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1426stick match - - X X
1427stick on - - X X
1428stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001429stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001430stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001431tcp-check connect - - X X
1432tcp-check expect - - X X
1433tcp-check send - - X X
1434tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001435tcp-request connection - X X -
1436tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001437tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001438tcp-response content - - X X
1439tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001440timeout check X - X X
1441timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001442timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001443timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1444timeout connect X - X X
1445timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1446timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1447timeout http-request X X X X
1448timeout queue X - X X
1449timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001450timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001451timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1452timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001453timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001454transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001455unique-id-format X X X -
1456unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001457use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001458use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001459------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1460 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014634.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1464---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001465
1466This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1467
1468
1469acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1470 Declare or complete an access list.
1471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1472 no | yes | yes | yes
1473 Example:
1474 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1475 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1476 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001478 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479
1480
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001481appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1482 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001483 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1485 no | no | yes | yes
1486 Arguments :
1487 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1488 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1489
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001490 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 checked in each cookie value.
1492
1493 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1494 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1495 milliseconds.
1496
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001497 request-learn
1498 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1499 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1500 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1501 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1502 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1503 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1504
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001505 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1506 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1507 data following this prefix.
1508
1509 Example :
1510 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1511
1512 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1513 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1514
1515 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1516 2 modes are currently supported :
1517 - path-parameters :
1518 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1519 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1520 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1521 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1522 - query-string :
1523 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1524 query string.
1525
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001526 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1527 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1528 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1529 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001530 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1531 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1532 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001533 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1534 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1535
1536 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1537
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001538 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1539 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1540 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1541
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001542 Example :
1543 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1544
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001545 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1546 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001547
1548
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001549backlog <conns>
1550 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1552 yes | yes | yes | no
1553 Arguments :
1554 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1555 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001556 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001557
1558 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1559 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1560 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1561 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1562 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1563 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1564 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1565 backlog parameter.
1566
1567 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1568 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1569 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1570
1571 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1572
1573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001574balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001575balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001576 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1578 yes | no | yes | yes
1579 Arguments :
1580 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1581 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1582 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1583 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1584
1585 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1586 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1587 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1588 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001589 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001590 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001591 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1592 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1593 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1594 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1595 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1596 it, so that you don't worry.
1597
1598 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1599 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1600 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1601 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1602 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1603 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1604 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1605 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001607 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1608 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1609 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1610 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1611 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1612 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1613 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1614 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1615
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001616 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001617 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001618 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1619 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001620 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001621 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1622 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1623 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1624 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1625 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001626 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1627 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1628 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1629 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1630 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1631 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001633 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1634 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1635 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1636 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1637 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1638 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1639 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1640 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001641 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001642 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001643 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1644 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1645 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001646
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001647 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1648 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1649 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1650 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1651 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1652 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1653 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1654 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1655 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1656 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1657 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1658 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001659
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001660 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001661 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1662 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1663 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1664 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1665 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1666 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1667 URIs start with a leading "/".
1668
1669 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1670 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1671 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1672 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1673
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001674 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001675 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1676
1677 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001678 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1679 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001680 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1681 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1682 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1683 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001684 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001685 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1686 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001687
1688 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1689 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1690 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1691 server will receive the request.
1692
1693 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1694 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1695 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1696 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1697 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001698 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1699 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1700 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001701
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001702 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1703 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1704 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1705 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1706 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001708 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001709 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1710 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1711 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1712
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001713 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1714 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1715 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1716
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001717 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001718 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001719 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1720 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1721 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1722 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1723 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1724 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001725 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001726 used instead.
1727
1728 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1729 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1730 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1731 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1732
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001733 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1734 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1735 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1736
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001737 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001738
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001739 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001740 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1741 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001742
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001743 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1744 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1745 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001746
1747 Examples :
1748 balance roundrobin
1749 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001750 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001751 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1752 balance hdr(host)
1753 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001754
1755 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1756 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1757
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001758 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001759 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1760 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1761 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1762 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1763
1764 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1765 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1766 defaults to 16 kB.
1767
1768 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1769 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1770
1771 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1772 Round Robin.
1773
1774 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1775 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1776 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1777 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1778
1779 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1780
1781 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001782 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001783 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1784 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1785 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001787 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1788 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001789
1790
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001791bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1792bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001793 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1795 no | yes | yes | no
1796 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001797 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1798 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1799 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1800 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001801 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001802 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1803 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1804 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1805 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1806 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1807 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1808 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaub4fca5d2014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001809 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1810 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1811 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1812 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1813 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1814 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1815 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001816 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1817 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1818 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001819 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1820 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1821 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1822 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001823
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001824 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1825 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001826 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1827 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1828 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001829 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1830 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1831 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1832 the range.
1833
1834 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1835 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1836 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1837 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1838 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1839 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1840 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001841 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001842 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001843
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001844 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1845 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1846 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1847 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1848 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1849 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1850 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1851 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1852
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001853 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1854 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1855 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1856 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001858 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1859 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1860 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1861 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1862 in a frontend.
1863
1864 Example :
1865 listen http_proxy
1866 bind :80,:443
1867 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001868 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001870 listen http_https_proxy
1871 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001872 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001873
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001874 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1875 bind ipv6@:80
1876 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1877 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1878
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001879 listen external_bind_app1
1880 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1881
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001882 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001883 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001884
1885
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001886bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001887 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1889 yes | yes | yes | yes
1890 Arguments :
1891 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1892 may be used to override a default value.
1893
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001894 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001895 option may be combined with other numbers.
1896
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001897 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001898 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1899 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1900 missing from all processes.
1901
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001902 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001903 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001904 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1905 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1906 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1907 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001908
1909 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1910 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1911 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1912 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1913 and 'even' instances.
1914
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001915 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1916 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1917 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1918 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001919
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001920 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1921 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1922
Willy Tarreaue56c4f12014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001923 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1924 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1925 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1926
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001927 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1928 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1929
1930 Example :
1931 listen app_ip1
1932 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001933 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001934
1935 listen app_ip2
1936 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001937 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001938
1939 listen management
1940 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001941 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001942
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001943 listen management
1944 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1945 bind-process 1-4
1946
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001947 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001948
1949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001950block { if | unless } <condition>
1951 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1953 no | yes | yes | yes
1954
1955 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1956 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001957 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001958 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1960 "block" statements per instance.
1961
1962 Example:
1963 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1964 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1965 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1966 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001968 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969
1970
1971capture cookie <name> len <length>
1972 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1974 no | yes | yes | no
1975 Arguments :
1976 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1977 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1978 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1979 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1980 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1981
1982 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1983 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1984 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1985 right if it exceeds <length>.
1986
1987 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1988 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1989 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1990 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1991
1992 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1993 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1994 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1995
1996 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1997 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1998 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001999 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2000 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2001 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002
2003 Example:
2004 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2005
2006 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002007 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002008
2009
2010capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002011 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2013 no | yes | yes | no
2014 Arguments :
2015 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002016 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2018 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2019 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2020
2021 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2022 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2023 it exceeds <length>.
2024
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002025 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002026 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2027 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002028 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2029 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2030 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2031 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002032 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002033 environments to find where the request came from.
2034
2035 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2036 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2037 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2038 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002039
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002040 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2041 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2042 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2043 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2044 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045
2046 Example:
2047 capture request header Host len 15
2048 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2049 capture request header Referrer len 15
2050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002051 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052 about logging.
2053
2054
2055capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002056 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2058 no | yes | yes | no
2059 Arguments :
2060 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002061 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002062 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2063 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2064 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2065
2066 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2067 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2068 it exceeds <length>.
2069
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002070 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2072 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2073 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002074 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2075 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2076 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2077 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002078
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002079 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2080 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2081 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2082 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2083 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
2085 Example:
2086 capture response header Content-length len 9
2087 capture response header Location len 15
2088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002089 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090 about logging.
2091
2092
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002093clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002094 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2096 yes | yes | yes | no
2097 Arguments :
2098 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2099 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2100 as explained at the top of this document.
2101
2102 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2103 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2104 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2105 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2106 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2107 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2108 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2109 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002110 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002111 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2112 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2113
2114 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2115 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2116 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2117 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2118 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2119 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2120
2121 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2122 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2123
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002124 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2125 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002126
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002127compression algo <algorithm> ...
2128compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002129compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002130 Enable HTTP compression.
2131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2132 yes | yes | yes | yes
2133 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002134 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2135 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2136 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2137
2138 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002139 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002140 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2141 data.
2142
2143 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2144 support for zlib was built in.
2145
2146 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2147 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2148 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2149 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2150 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2151 in.
2152
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002153 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002154 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002155 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2156 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2157 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2158 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2159 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002160
2161 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2162 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2163 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2164 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2165 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002166 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2167 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2168 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2169 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2170 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreau4cf57af2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002171 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2172 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002173
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002174 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002175 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2176 "Accept-Encoding" header
2177 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002178 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002179 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2180 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002181 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2182 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2183 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2184 "multipart"
2185 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2186 header
2187 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2188 and later
2189 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2190 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002191
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002192 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2193 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002194
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002195 Examples :
2196 compression algo gzip
2197 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002199contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2202 yes | no | yes | yes
2203 Arguments :
2204 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2205 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2206 as explained at the top of this document.
2207
2208 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002209 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002210 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002211 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2212 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2213 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2214 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2215
2216 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2217 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2218 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2219 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2220 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2221 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2222
2223 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2224 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2225 instead.
2226
2227 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2228 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2229
2230
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002231cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002232 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2233 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002234 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2236 yes | no | yes | yes
2237 Arguments :
2238 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2239 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2240 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2241 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2242 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2243 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2244 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2245 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2246 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2247
2248 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2249 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2250 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2251 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2252 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2253 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2254 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2255 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2256 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2257 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2258 "insert" and "prefix".
2259
2260 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002261 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002262
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002263 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002264 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2265 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2266 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2267 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2268 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2269 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2270 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2271 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2272 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2273 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274
2275 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2276 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2277 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2278 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2279 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2280 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2281 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2282 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2283 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2284 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002285 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2286 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2287 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002288
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002289 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2290 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2291 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002292 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2293 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2294 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2295 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002296 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2297 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2298 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299
2300 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2301 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2302 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2303 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2304 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2305 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2306 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2307 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2308 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2309
2310 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2311 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2312 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2313 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2314 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2315 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2316 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2317 persistence cookie in the cache.
2318 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2319
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002320 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2321 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2322 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2323 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2324 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2325 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2326 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2327 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2328 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2329 they logout.
2330
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002331 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2332 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2333 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2334 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2335
2336 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2337 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2338 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2339 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2340 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2341 this attribute.
2342
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002343 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002344 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002345 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2346 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2347 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2348 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2349 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2350 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002351
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002352 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2353 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2354 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2355 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2356 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2357 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2358 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2359 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2360 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2361 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2362 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2363 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2364 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2365 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2366 the site.
2367
2368 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2369 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2370 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2371 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2372 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2373 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2374 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2375 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2376 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2377 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2378 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2379 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2380 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2381 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2382 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2383 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2384
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2386 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2387 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2388 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390 Examples :
2391 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2392 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2393 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002394 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002395
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002396 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002397 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002398
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002400default-server [param*]
2401 Change default options for a server in a backend
2402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2403 yes | no | yes | yes
2404 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002405 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2406 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2407 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2408 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002409
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002410 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002411 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2412
2413 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002414
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002416default_backend <backend>
2417 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2419 yes | yes | yes | no
2420 Arguments :
2421 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2422
2423 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2424 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2425 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2426 will catch all undetermined requests.
2427
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428 Example :
2429
2430 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2431 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2432 default_backend dynamic
2433
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002434 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002437description <string>
2438 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2440 no | yes | yes | yes
2441 Arguments : string
2442
2443 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2444 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2445 it describes.
2446 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2447
2448
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002449disabled
2450 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2452 yes | yes | yes | yes
2453 Arguments : none
2454
2455 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2456 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2457 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2458 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2459 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2460 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2461 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2462
2463 See also : "enabled"
2464
2465
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002466dispatch <address>:<port>
2467 Set a default server address
2468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2469 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002470 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002471
2472 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2473 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2474 during start-up.
2475
2476 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2477 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2478 possible with normal servers.
2479
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002480 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002481 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2482 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2483 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2484 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2485
2486 See also : "server"
2487
2488
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002489enabled
2490 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2492 yes | yes | yes | yes
2493 Arguments : none
2494
2495 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2496 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2497
2498 See also : "disabled"
2499
2500
2501errorfile <code> <file>
2502 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2504 yes | yes | yes | yes
2505 Arguments :
2506 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002507 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002508
2509 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002510 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002512 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2513 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002514
2515 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2516 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2517 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2518
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002519 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2520
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002521 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2522 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2523 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2524 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2525
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002526 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2527 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2528 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2529 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2530 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2531 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2534 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2535 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002536 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002537 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2538
2539 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2540
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002541 Example :
2542 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002543 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002544 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2545 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2546
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002547
2548errorloc <code> <url>
2549errorloc302 <code> <url>
2550 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2552 yes | yes | yes | yes
2553 Arguments :
2554 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002555 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002556
2557 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2558 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2559 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2560 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2561 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2562
2563 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2564 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2565 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2566
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002567 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002569 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2570 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2571 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2572 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2573 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2574 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2575 request.
2576
2577 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2578
2579
2580errorloc303 <code> <url>
2581 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2583 yes | yes | yes | yes
2584 Arguments :
2585 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2586 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2587
2588 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2589 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2590 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2591 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2592 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2593
2594 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2595 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2596 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2597
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002598 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2599
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002600 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2601 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2602 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2603 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002604 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002605
2606 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2607
2608
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002609force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2610 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 no | yes | yes | yes
2613
2614 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2615 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2616 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2617 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2618 marked down for maintenance operations.
2619
2620 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2621 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2622 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2623 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2624 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2625 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2626 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2627 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2628 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2629
2630 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2631 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2632 is used.
2633
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002634 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002635 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002636
2637
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002638fullconn <conns>
2639 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2641 yes | no | yes | yes
2642 Arguments :
2643 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2644 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2645
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002646 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002647 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002648 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002649 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2650 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2651 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2652 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2653 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002654 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002655
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002656 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2657 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002658 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2659 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2660 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002661
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002662 Example :
2663 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2664 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2665 # connections.
2666 backend dynamic
2667 fullconn 10000
2668 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2669 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2670
2671 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2672
2673
2674grace <time>
2675 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002677 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002678 Arguments :
2679 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2680 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2681 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2682
2683 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2684 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002685 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002686 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2687
2688 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2689 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2690 simplify it.
2691
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002692
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002693hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002694 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2696 yes | no | yes | yes
2697 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002698 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2699 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002700
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002701 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2702 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2703 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2704 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2705 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2706 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2707 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2708 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2709 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2710 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002711
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002712 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2713 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2714 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2715 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2716 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2717 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2718 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2719 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2720 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2721 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2722 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2723 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2724 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002725 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2726 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002727
2728 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2729
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002730 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002731 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2732 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2733 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002734 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2735 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2736 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002737
2738 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2739 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002740 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2741 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2742 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2743 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2744
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002745 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2746 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2747 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2748 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2749 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2750 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2751 parameter.
2752
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002753 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2754
2755 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2756 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2757 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2758 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2759 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2760 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2761 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2762 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2763 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2764 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2765 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2766 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002767
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002768 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2769 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2770 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002771
2772 See also : "balance", "server"
2773
2774
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002775http-check disable-on-404
2776 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002778 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002779 Arguments : none
2780
2781 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2782 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2783 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2784 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2785 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2786 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2787 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2788 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002789 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2790 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2791 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2792
2793 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2794
2795
2796http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002797 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002799 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002800 Arguments :
2801 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2802 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002803 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002804 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2805 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2806 details on the supported keywords.
2807
2808 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2809 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2810 with the usual backslash ('\').
2811
2812 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2813 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2814 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2815 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2816 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2817
2818 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002819 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002820 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2821 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2822 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2823
2824 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002825 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002826 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2827 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2828 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2829 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2830
2831 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002832 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002833 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2834 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2835 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2836 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2837 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2838 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2839 trace).
2840
2841 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002842 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002843 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2844 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2845 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2846 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2847 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2848 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2849
2850 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2851 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2852 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2853 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2854 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2855 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2856 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2857 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2858
Cyril Bontéa448e162015-01-30 00:07:07 +01002859 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
2860 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
2861 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
2862
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002863 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2864 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2865
2866 Examples :
2867 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002868 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002869
2870 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002871 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002872
2873 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002874 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002875
2876 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002877 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002879 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002880
2881
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002882http-check send-state
2883 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2885 yes | no | yes | yes
2886 Arguments : none
2887
2888 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2889 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2890 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2891 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2892 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2893
2894 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2895 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2896 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2897 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2898 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2899 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2900 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2901 checked in multiple backends.
2902
2903 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2904 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2905
2906 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2907 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2908 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2909 one fails.
2910
2911 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2912 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2913 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2914
2915 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2916 server's queue.
2917
2918 Example of a header received by the application server :
2919 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2920 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2921
2922 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2923
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002924http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002925 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002926 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002927 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2928 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002929 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2930 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2931 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2932 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2933 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2934 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002935 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002936 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2937
2938 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2939 no | yes | yes | yes
2940
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002941 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2942 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2943 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2944 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2945 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002946
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002947 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2948 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2949 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2950
2951 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2952 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2953 are evaluated.
2954
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002955 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2956 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2957 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2958 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2959 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2960 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2961 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2962 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2963 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002964 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002965 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2966
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002967 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2968 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2969 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2970 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2971 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2972
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002973 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2974 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2975 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002976 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2977 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002978
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002979 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2980 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2981 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2982 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2983 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2984 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2985 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2986 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2987
2988 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2989 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2990 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreaufcf75d22015-01-21 20:39:27 +01002991 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
2992 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002993
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002994 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2995 <name>.
2996
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002997 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
2998 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
2999 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3000 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3001 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3002 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3003 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3004 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3005
3006 Example:
3007
3008 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3009
3010 applied to:
3011
3012 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3013
3014 outputs:
3015
3016 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3017
3018 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3019
3020 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3021 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3022 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3023 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3024 header.
3025
3026 Example:
3027
3028 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3029
3030 applied to:
3031
3032 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3033
3034 outputs:
3035
3036 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3037
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003038 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3039 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3040 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3041 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3042 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3043 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3044 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3045 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3046
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003047 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3048 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3049 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3050 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3051 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3052 another equipment.
3053
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003054 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3055 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3056 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3057 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3058 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3059 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3060 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3061 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3062
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003063 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3064 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3065 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3066 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3067 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3068 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3069 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3070 admin privileges.
3071
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003072 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3073 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3074 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3075 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3076 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3077 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3078 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3079 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3080
3081 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3082 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3083 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3084 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3085 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3086 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3087
3088 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3089 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3090 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3091 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3092 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3093 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3094
3095 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3096 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3097 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3098 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3099 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3100 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3101 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3102 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3103 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3104
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003105 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3106
3107 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3108 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3109 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3110 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003111
3112 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003113 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3114 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3115 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003116
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003117 http-request allow if nagios
3118 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3119 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3120 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003121
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003122 Example:
3123 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003124 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003125
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003126 Example:
3127 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3128 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3129 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3130 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3131 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3132 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3133 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3134 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3135 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3136
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003137 Example:
3138 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3139 acl add path /addacl
3140 acl del path /delacl
3141
3142 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3143
3144 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3145 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3146
3147 Example:
3148 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3149 acl setmap path /setmap
3150 acl delmap path /delmap
3151
3152 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3153
3154 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3155 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3156
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003157 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3158 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003159
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003160http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003161 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003162 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3163 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003164 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3165 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3166 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3167 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3168 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3169 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003170 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003171 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3172
3173 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3174 no | yes | yes | yes
3175
3176 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3177 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3178 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3179 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3180 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3181 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3182
3183 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3184 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3185 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3186 current section.
3187
3188 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3189 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3190 rules are evaluated.
3191
3192 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3193 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3194 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3195 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3196 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3197 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3198 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3199
3200 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3201 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3202 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3203 external users.
3204
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003205 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3206 <name>.
3207
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003208 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3209 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3210 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3211 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3212 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3213 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3214 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3215 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3216
3217 Example:
3218
3219 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3220
3221 applied to:
3222
3223 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3224
3225 outputs:
3226
3227 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3228
3229 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3230
3231 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3232 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3233 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3234 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3235 header.
3236
3237 Example:
3238
3239 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3240
3241 applied to:
3242
3243 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3244
3245 outputs:
3246
3247 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3248
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003249 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3250 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3251 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3252 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3253 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3254 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3255 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3256 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3257
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003258 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3259 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3260 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3261 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3262 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3263 another equipment.
3264
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003265 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3266 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3267 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3268 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3269 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3270 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3271 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3272 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3273
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003274 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3275 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3276 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3277 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3278 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3279 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3280 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3281 admin privileges.
3282
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003283 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3284 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3285 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3286 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3287 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3288 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3289 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3290 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3291
3292 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3293 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3294 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3295 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3296 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3297 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3298
3299 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3300 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3301 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3302 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3303 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3304 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3305
3306 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3307 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3308 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3309 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3310 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3311 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3312 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3313 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3314 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3315
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003316 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3317
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003318 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003319 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3320 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3321 rules.
3322
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003323 Example:
3324 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3325
3326 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3327
3328 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3329 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3330
3331 Example:
3332 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3333
3334 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3335
3336 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3337 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3338
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003339 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3340 ACL usage.
3341
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003342
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003343http-send-name-header [<header>]
3344 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3345
3346 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3347 yes | no | yes | yes
3348
3349 Arguments :
3350
3351 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3352
3353 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3354 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3355 is added with the header string proved.
3356
3357 See also : "server"
3358
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003359id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003360 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3362 no | yes | yes | yes
3363 Arguments : none
3364
3365 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3366 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3367 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003368
3369
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003370ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3371 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3372 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3373 no | yes | yes | yes
3374
3375 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3376 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3377 and running).
3378
3379 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3380 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3381 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003382 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003383 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3384
3385 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3386 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3387
3388 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3389 "unless" condition is met.
3390
3391 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3392
3393
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003394log global
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003395log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003396no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003397 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3399 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003400
3401 Prefix :
3402 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3403 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3404 prefix does not allow arguments.
3405
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003406 Arguments :
3407 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3408 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3409 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3410 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3411 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3412 parameter.
3413
3414 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3415 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3416
3417 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3418 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3419 standard syslog port).
3420
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003421 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3422 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3423 standard syslog port).
3424
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003425 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3426 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3427 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3428 appropriately writeable).
3429
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003430 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3431 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3432 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3433 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3434
Willy Tarreaudc2695c2014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003435 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3436 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3437 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3438 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3439 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3440 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3441 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3442 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3443 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3444 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3445 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3446
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003447 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3448
3449 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3450 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3451 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3452
3453 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3454 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3455 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003456 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3457 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3458 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3459 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3460 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003461
3462 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3463
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003464 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3465 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3466 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003467
3468 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3469 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3470 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3471 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3472
3473 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3474 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003475
3476 Example :
3477 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003478 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3479 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003480 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3481
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003482
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003483log-format <string>
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003484 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3485 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3486 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003487
Willy Tarreau14104732015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003488 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3489 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3490 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3491 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3492 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003493
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003494
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003495max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3496 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3497 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3498 yes | no | yes | yes
3499
3500 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3501 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3502 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3503 servers.
3504
3505 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3506 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3507 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3508 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3509 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3510 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3511 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3512 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3513 picking a different server.
3514
3515 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3516 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3517 even if they have to be queued.
3518
3519 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3520 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3521
3522
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003523maxconn <conns>
3524 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3526 yes | yes | yes | no
3527 Arguments :
3528 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3529 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3530 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3531 closes.
3532
3533 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3534 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3535 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3536 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3537 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3538 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3539 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3540 properly tuned.
3541
3542 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3543 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3544 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3545
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003546 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3547
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003548 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3549
3550
3551mode { tcp|http|health }
3552 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3554 yes | yes | yes | yes
3555 Arguments :
3556 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3557 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3558 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3559 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3560
3561 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3562 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3563 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3564 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3565 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3566
3567 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003568 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3569 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3570 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3571 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3572 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3573 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3574 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003575
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003576 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3577 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3578 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003579
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003580 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003581 defaults http_instances
3582 mode http
3583
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003584 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003585
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003586
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003587monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003588 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3590 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003591 Arguments :
3592 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3593 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003594 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003595 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3596 backend and its backup.
3597
3598 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3599 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3600 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3601 servers in a list of backends.
3602
3603 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3604 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3605 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3606 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3607 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3608 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3609 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003610 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3611 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003612
3613 Example:
3614 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003615 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003616 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3617 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3618 monitor-uri /site_alive
3619 monitor fail if site_dead
3620
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003621 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003622
3623
3624monitor-net <source>
3625 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3627 yes | yes | yes | no
3628 Arguments :
3629 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3630 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3631 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3632 followed by a mask.
3633
3634 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3635 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003636 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003637 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3638
3639 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3640 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3641 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3642 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003643 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3644 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3645 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003646
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003647 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3648 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3649 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3650 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3651 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3652 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003653
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003654 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3655 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003656
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003657 Example :
3658 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3659 frontend www
3660 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3661
3662 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3663
3664
3665monitor-uri <uri>
3666 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3668 yes | yes | yes | no
3669 Arguments :
3670 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3671 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3672
3673 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3674 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3675 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3676 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3677 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3678 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3679 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3680 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3681
3682 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3683 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3684 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3685 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3686 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3687 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3688
3689 Example :
3690 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3691 frontend www
3692 mode http
3693 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3694
3695 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3696
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003697
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003698option abortonclose
3699no option abortonclose
3700 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3702 yes | no | yes | yes
3703 Arguments : none
3704
3705 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3706 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3707 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3708 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003709 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003710 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3711 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3712 encountered while delivering the response.
3713
3714 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3715 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3716 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3717 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3718 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3719 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003720 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003721 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003722 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003723 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3724 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3725 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3726
3727 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3728 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3729 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3730 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3731 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3732 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3733 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3734 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003735 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003736
3737 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3738 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3739
3740 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3741
3742
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003743option accept-invalid-http-request
3744no option accept-invalid-http-request
3745 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3747 yes | yes | yes | no
3748 Arguments : none
3749
3750 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3751 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3752 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3753 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3754 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3755 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3756 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3757 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003758 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3759 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3760 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3761 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3762 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3763 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003764
3765 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3766 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3767 been confirmed.
3768
3769 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3770 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003771 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3772 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003773 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3774
3775 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3776 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3777
3778 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3779 stats socket.
3780
3781
3782option accept-invalid-http-response
3783no option accept-invalid-http-response
3784 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3786 yes | no | yes | yes
3787 Arguments : none
3788
3789 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3790 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3791 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3792 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3793 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3794 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3795 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3796 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3797 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3798
3799 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3800 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3801 been confirmed.
3802
3803 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3804 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3805 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3806 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3807
3808 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3809 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3810
3811 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3812 stats socket.
3813
3814
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003815option allbackups
3816no option allbackups
3817 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3819 yes | no | yes | yes
3820 Arguments : none
3821
3822 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3823 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3824 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3825 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3826 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3827 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3828 order between the backup servers anymore.
3829
3830 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3831 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3832
3833 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3834 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3835
3836
3837option checkcache
3838no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003839 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3841 yes | no | yes | yes
3842 Arguments : none
3843
3844 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3845 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003846 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003847 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3848 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003849 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003850
3851 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003852 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003853 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003854 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3855 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003856 to the client are :
3857 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003858 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003859 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003860 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3861 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3862 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3863 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3864 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3865 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3866 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3867 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3868 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3869 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3870 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3871
3872 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003873 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003874 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003875 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003876 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3877
3878 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3879 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003880 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003881 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3882
3883 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3884 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3885
3886
3887option clitcpka
3888no option clitcpka
3889 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3891 yes | yes | yes | no
3892 Arguments : none
3893
3894 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3895 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3896 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3897 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3898
3899 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3900 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3901 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3902 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3903
3904 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3905 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3906 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3907 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3908 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3909
3910 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3911
3912 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3913 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3914 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3915
3916 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3917 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3918
3919 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3920
3921
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003922option contstats
3923 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3925 yes | yes | yes | no
3926 Arguments : none
3927
3928 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3929 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3930 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3931 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3932 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3933 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3934 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3935
3936
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003937option dontlog-normal
3938no option dontlog-normal
3939 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3941 yes | yes | yes | no
3942 Arguments : none
3943
3944 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3945 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3946 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3947 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3948 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3949 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3950 logged.
3951
3952 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3953 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3954 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003956 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003957 logging.
3958
3959
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003960option dontlognull
3961no option dontlognull
3962 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3964 yes | yes | yes | no
3965 Arguments : none
3966
3967 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3968 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3969 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3970 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3971 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3972 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3973 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3974
3975 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3976 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3977 would not be logged.
3978
3979 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3980 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003982 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003983
3984
3985option forceclose
3986no option forceclose
3987 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003989 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003990 Arguments : none
3991
3992 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3993 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3994 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3995 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3996 global session times in the logs.
3997
3998 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003999 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004000 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004001
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004002 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4003 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4004 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4005
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004006 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4007 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004008
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004009 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4010 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4011
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004012 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004013
4014
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004015option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004016 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4018 yes | yes | yes | yes
4019 Arguments :
4020 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4021 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004022 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004023 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004024
4025 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4026 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4027 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4028 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4029 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4030 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4031 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004032 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4033 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4034 possible that the client has already brought one.
4035
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004036 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004037 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004038 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4039 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004040 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4041 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004042
4043 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4044 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4045 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4046 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4047 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4048 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4049 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4050
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004051 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4052 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4053 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4054 are under the control of the end-user.
4055
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004056 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004057 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4058 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004059 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4060 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4061 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004062
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004063 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004064 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4065 frontend www
4066 mode http
4067 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4068
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004069 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4070 backend www
4071 mode http
4072 option forwardfor header X-Client
4073
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004074 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004075 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004076
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004077
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004078option http-keep-alive
4079no option http-keep-alive
4080 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4082 yes | yes | yes | yes
4083 Arguments : none
4084
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004085 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4086 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4087 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4088 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4089 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4090 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4091 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4092
4093 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4094 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004095 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4096 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4097 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4098 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4099 situations where this option may be useful :
4100
4101 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4102 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4103
4104 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4105 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4106
4107 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4108 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4109 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4110 request.
4111
4112 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4113 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004114 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4115 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4116 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004117
4118 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4119 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4120
4121 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4122 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4123 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4124 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4125 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4126 not set.
4127
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004128 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4129 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004130 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004131 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004132
4133 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004134 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4135 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004136
4137
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004138option http-no-delay
4139no option http-no-delay
4140 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4142 yes | yes | yes | yes
4143 Arguments : none
4144
4145 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4146 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4147 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4148 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4149 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4150 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4151 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4152 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4153 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4154 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4155 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4156 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4157 affected.
4158
4159 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4160 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4161 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4162 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4163 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4164 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4165 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4166 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4167 latency environments.
4168
4169
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004170option http-pretend-keepalive
4171no option http-pretend-keepalive
4172 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4174 yes | yes | yes | yes
4175 Arguments : none
4176
4177 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4178 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4179 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4180 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4181 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4182 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4183 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4184 consider the response complete.
4185
4186 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4187 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4188 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4189 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4190 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4191 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4192
4193 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4194 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4195 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4196 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4197 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4198 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4199 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4200
4201 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4202 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004203 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004204 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4205 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004206
4207 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4208 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4209
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004210 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4211 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004212
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004213
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004214option http-server-close
4215no option http-server-close
4216 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4218 yes | yes | yes | yes
4219 Arguments : none
4220
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004221 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4222 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4223 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4224 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4225 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4226 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4227 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4228 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4229 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4230 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4231 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4232 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4233 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4234 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4235 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4236 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004237
4238 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4239 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4240 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4241 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004242 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4243 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004244
4245 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4246 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004247 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4248 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004249 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4250 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004251
4252 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4253 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4254
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004255 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004256 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4257 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004258
4259
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004260option http-tunnel
4261no option http-tunnel
4262 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4264 yes | yes | yes | yes
4265 Arguments : none
4266
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004267 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4268 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4269 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4270 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4271 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4272 "option http-tunnel".
4273
4274 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004275 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004276 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4277 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4278 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4279 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4280 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4281 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4282 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004283
4284 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4285 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4286
4287 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4288 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4289 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4290
4291
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004292option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004293no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004294 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4296 yes | yes | yes | no
4297 Arguments : none
4298
4299 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4300 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4301 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4302 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4303 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4304 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4305 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4306
4307 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4308 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4309 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4310 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4311 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4312 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4313 request along its whole life.
4314
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004315 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4316 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4317 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4318 front of an existing proxy.
4319
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004320 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4321
4322 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4323 http-server-close".
4324
4325
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004326option httpchk
4327option httpchk <uri>
4328option httpchk <method> <uri>
4329option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4330 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4332 yes | no | yes | yes
4333 Arguments :
4334 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4335 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4336 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4337 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4338 ones.
4339
4340 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4341 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4342 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4343
4344 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4345 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4346 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4347 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4348 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4349
4350 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4351 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4352 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4353 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4354 the lack of any response.
4355
4356 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4357
4358 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4359 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4360 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4361
4362 Examples :
4363 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4364 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4365 backend https_relay
4366 mode tcp
4367 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4368 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4369
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004370 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4371 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4372 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004373
4374
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004375option httpclose
4376no option httpclose
4377 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4379 yes | yes | yes | yes
4380 Arguments : none
4381
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004382 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4383 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4384 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4385 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004386 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004387 "option http-tunnel".
4388
4389 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4390 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4391 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4392 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4393 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4394 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4395 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4396 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004397
4398 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004399 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004400 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4401 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4402 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4403 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4404 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004405
4406 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4407 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004408 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4409 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004410 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4411 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004412
4413 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4414 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4415
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004416 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4417 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004418
4419
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004420option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004421 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4423 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004424 Arguments :
4425 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4426 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4427 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4428 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4429 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004430
4431 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4432 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4433 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4434 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4435 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4436 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4437 ports.
4438
4439 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4440
PiBa-NL211c2e92014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004441 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4442 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004444 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004445
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004446
4447option http_proxy
4448no option http_proxy
4449 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4451 yes | yes | yes | yes
4452 Arguments : none
4453
4454 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4455 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4456 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4457 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4458 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4459
4460 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4461 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4462 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4463 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004464 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004465 be analyzed.
4466
4467 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4468 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4469
4470 Example :
4471 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4472 backend direct_forward
4473 option httpclose
4474 option http_proxy
4475
4476 See also : "option httpclose"
4477
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004478
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004479option independent-streams
4480no option independent-streams
4481 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4483 yes | yes | yes | yes
4484 Arguments : none
4485
4486 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4487 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4488 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4489 receive data or not.
4490
4491 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4492 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4493 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4494 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4495 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4496 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4497 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4498 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4499 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4500 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4501 socket buffers.
4502
4503 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4504 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4505 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4506 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4507 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4508
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004509 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004510 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4511 deprecated.
4512
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004513 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004514
4515
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004516option ldap-check
4517 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4519 yes | no | yes | yes
4520 Arguments : none
4521
4522 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4523 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4524 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4525 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4526
4527 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4528 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4529
4530 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4531 configure it.
4532
4533 Example :
4534 option ldap-check
4535
4536 See also : "option httpchk"
4537
4538
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004539option log-health-checks
4540no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004541 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4543 yes | no | yes | yes
4544 Arguments : none
4545
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004546 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4547 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4548 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004549
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004550 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4551 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4552 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4553 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4554 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4555
4556 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4557 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004558
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004559 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4560 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4561 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004562
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004563
4564option log-separate-errors
4565no option log-separate-errors
4566 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4568 yes | yes | yes | no
4569 Arguments : none
4570
4571 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4572 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4573 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4574 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4575 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4576 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4577 provides very important information.
4578
4579 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4580 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4581 error logs.
4582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004583 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004584 logging.
4585
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004586
4587option logasap
4588no option logasap
4589 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4591 yes | yes | yes | no
4592 Arguments : none
4593
4594 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4595 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4596 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4597 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4598 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4599 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4600 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004601 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004602 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4603 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4604
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004605 Examples :
4606 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4607 mode http
4608 option httplog
4609 option logasap
4610 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4611
4612 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4613 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4614 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4615 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4616
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004617 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004618 logging.
4619
4620
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004621option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004622 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4624 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004625 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004626 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4627 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004628 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004629
4630 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4631 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4632 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4633 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4634 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4635 in the MySQL table, like this :
4636
4637 USE mysql;
4638 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4639 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4640
4641 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4642 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4643 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4644 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4645 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4646 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4647 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4648 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4649 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4650
4651 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4652 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004653
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004654 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004655
4656 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4657 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4658 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4659 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4660 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4661 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4662
4663 See also: "option httpchk"
4664
4665
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004666option nolinger
4667no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004668 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004669 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4670 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004671 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004672
4673 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4674 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4675 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4676 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4677 connections.
4678
4679 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4680 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4681 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4682 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4683 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4684 this too.
4685
4686 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4687 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4688 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4689
4690 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4691 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4692 for servers.
4693
4694 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4695 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4696
4697
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004698option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4699 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4701 yes | yes | yes | yes
4702 Arguments :
4703 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4704 matching <network>
4705 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4706 header name.
4707
4708 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4709 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4710 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4711 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4712 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4713 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4714 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4715 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4716 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4717 possible that the client has already brought one.
4718
4719 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4720 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4721 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4722 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4723 header and requires different one.
4724
4725 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4726 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4727 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4728 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4729 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4730 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4731 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4732
4733 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4734 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4735 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4736 both are defined.
4737
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004738 Examples :
4739 # Original Destination address
4740 frontend www
4741 mode http
4742 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4743
4744 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4745 backend www
4746 mode http
4747 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4748
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004749 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4750 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004751
4752
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004753option persist
4754no option persist
4755 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4756 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4757 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004758 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004759
4760 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4761 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4762 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4763 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4764 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4765 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4766 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4767 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4768 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4769 redirected to another valid server.
4770
4771 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4772 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4773
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004774 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004775
4776
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004777option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4778 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4780 yes | no | yes | yes
4781 Arguments :
4782 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4783 PostgreSQL server.
4784
4785 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4786 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4787 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4788 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4789
4790 See also: "option httpchk"
4791
4792
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004793option prefer-last-server
4794no option prefer-last-server
4795 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4796 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4797 yes | no | yes | yes
4798 Arguments : none
4799
4800 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4801 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4802 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4803 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4804 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4805 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4806 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4807 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4808 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004809 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4810 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4811 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4812 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4813 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4814 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4815 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004816
4817 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4818 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4819
4820 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4821
4822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004823option redispatch
4824no option redispatch
4825 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4827 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004828 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004829
4830 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4831 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4832 be able to access the service anymore.
4833
4834 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4835 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4836
4837 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4838 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4839 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004840
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004841 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4842 "redisp" keywords.
4843
4844 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4845 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4846
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004847 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004848
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004849
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004850option redis-check
4851 Use redis health checks for server testing
4852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4853 yes | no | yes | yes
4854 Arguments : none
4855
4856 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4857 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4858 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4859 find the "+PONG" response message.
4860
4861 Example :
4862 option redis-check
4863
4864 See also : "option httpchk"
4865
4866
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004867option smtpchk
4868option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4869 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4871 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004872 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004873 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4874 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4875 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4876
4877 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4878 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4879 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4880
4881 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4882 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4883 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4884 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4885 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4886 dead server.
4887
4888 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4889 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4890 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4891 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4892
4893 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4894 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4895 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4896 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4897 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4898
4899 Example :
4900 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4901
4902 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4903
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004904
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004905option socket-stats
4906no option socket-stats
4907
4908 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4910 yes | yes | yes | no
4911
4912 Arguments : none
4913
4914
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004915option splice-auto
4916no option splice-auto
4917 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4919 yes | yes | yes | yes
4920 Arguments : none
4921
4922 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4923 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4924 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4925 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004926 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004927 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4928 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4929 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4930 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4931
4932 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4933 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4934 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4935 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4936 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4937 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4938 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4939 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4940 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4941 keyword.
4942
4943 Example :
4944 option splice-auto
4945
4946 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4947 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4948
4949 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4950 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4951
4952
4953option splice-request
4954no option splice-request
4955 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4957 yes | yes | yes | yes
4958 Arguments : none
4959
4960 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004961 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004962 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4963 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4964 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4965 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4966
4967 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4968
4969 Example :
4970 option splice-request
4971
4972 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4973 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4974
4975 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4976 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4977
4978
4979option splice-response
4980no option splice-response
4981 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4983 yes | yes | yes | yes
4984 Arguments : none
4985
4986 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004987 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004988 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4989 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4990 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4991 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4992
4993 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4994
4995 Example :
4996 option splice-response
4997
4998 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4999 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5000
5001 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5002 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5003
5004
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005005option srvtcpka
5006no option srvtcpka
5007 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5009 yes | no | yes | yes
5010 Arguments : none
5011
5012 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5013 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5014 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5015 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5016
5017 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5018 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5019 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5020 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5021
5022 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5023 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5024 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5025 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5026 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5027
5028 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5029
5030 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5031 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5032 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5033
5034 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5035 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5036
5037 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5038
5039
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005040option ssl-hello-chk
5041 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5043 yes | no | yes | yes
5044 Arguments : none
5045
5046 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5047 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5048 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5049 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5050 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5051 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5052 hello message.
5053
5054 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5055 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5056 messages, which is appreciable.
5057
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005058 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5059 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5060 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005061
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005062 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5063
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005064
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005065option tcp-check
5066 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5067 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5068 yes | no | yes | yes
5069
5070 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5071 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5072
5073 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5074 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5075 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5076
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005077 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005078 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5079 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5080 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5081 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5082 only.
5083
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005084 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005085 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5086 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5087 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5088 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5089
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005090 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005091 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5092 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005093 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005094 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5095 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5096 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5097 the respective protocols.
5098 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5099 analysed.
5100
5101 Examples :
5102 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5103 option tcp-check
5104 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5105
5106 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5107 option tcp-check
5108 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5109
5110 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5111 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005112 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005113 option tcp-check
5114 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5115 tcp-check expect +PONG
5116 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5117 tcp-check expect string role:master
5118 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5119 tcp-check expect string +OK
5120
5121 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5122 (send many headers before analyzing)
5123 option tcp-check
5124 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5125 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5126 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5127 tcp-check send \r\n
5128 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5129
5130
5131 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5132
5133
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005134option tcp-smart-accept
5135no option tcp-smart-accept
5136 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5138 yes | yes | yes | no
5139 Arguments : none
5140
5141 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5142 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5143 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5144 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5145 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5146 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5147
5148 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5149 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5150 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5151 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5152
5153 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5154 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5155 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5156 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5157
5158 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5159 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5160 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5161
5162 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5163 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5164 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5165
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005166 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5167
5168
5169option tcp-smart-connect
5170no option tcp-smart-connect
5171 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5173 yes | no | yes | yes
5174 Arguments : none
5175
5176 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5177 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5178 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5179 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5180 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5181
5182 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5183 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5184 complex.
5185
5186 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5187 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5188 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5189
5190 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5191 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5192
5193 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5194
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005195
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005196option tcpka
5197 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5199 yes | yes | yes | yes
5200 Arguments : none
5201
5202 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5203 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5204 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5205 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5206
5207 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5208 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5209 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5210 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5211
5212 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5213 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5214 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5215 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5216 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5217
5218 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5219
5220 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5221 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5222 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5223 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5224 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5225 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5226 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5227 backends.
5228
5229 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5230
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005231
5232option tcplog
5233 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5235 yes | yes | yes | yes
5236 Arguments : none
5237
5238 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5239 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5240 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5241 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5242 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5243 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5244 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5245 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5246
5247 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5248
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005249 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005250
5251
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005252option transparent
5253no option transparent
5254 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005256 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005257 Arguments : none
5258
5259 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5260 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5261 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5262 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5263 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5264 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5265 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5266 appropriate server.
5267
5268 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5269 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5270
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005271 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005272 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005273
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005274
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005275persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005276persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005277 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5279 yes | no | yes | yes
5280 Arguments :
5281 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005282 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5283 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005284
5285 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5286 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5287 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5288 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5289 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5290 forwarded to this server.
5291
5292 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5293 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5294 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005295 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005296 a single "listen" section.
5297
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005298 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5299 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5300 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5301
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005302 Example :
5303 listen tse-farm
5304 bind :3389
5305 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5306 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5307 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5308 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5309 persist rdp-cookie
5310 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005311 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005312 balance rdp-cookie
5313 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5314 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5315
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005316 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5317 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005318
5319
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005320rate-limit sessions <rate>
5321 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5323 yes | yes | yes | no
5324 Arguments :
5325 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5326 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5327
5328 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5329 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5330 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5331 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5332 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5333 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5334
5335 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5336 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5337 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5338 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5339
5340 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5341 listen smtp
5342 mode tcp
5343 bind :25
5344 rate-limit sessions 10
5345 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5346
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005347 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5348 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5349 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005350
5351 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5352
5353
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005354redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5355redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5356redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005357 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5359 no | yes | yes | yes
5360
5361 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005362 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005363
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005364 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005365 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005366 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5367 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5368 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005369
5370 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5371 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5372 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5373 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5374 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005375 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5376 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5377 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5378 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005379
5380 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5381 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5382 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5383 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5384 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5385 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005386 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005387 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005388 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5389 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5390 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005391
5392 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005393 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5394 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5395 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5396 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5397 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5398 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5399 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5400 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005401
5402 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5403 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5404
5405 - "drop-query"
5406 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5407 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5408 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5409 with a location-type redirect.
5410
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005411 - "append-slash"
5412 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5413 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5414 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5415 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5416
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005417 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5418 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5419 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5420 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5421 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5422 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5423 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5424
5425 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5426 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5427 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5428 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5429 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5430 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5431 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005432
5433 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5434 acl clear dst_port 80
5435 acl secure dst_port 8080
5436 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005437 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005438 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005439 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5440
5441 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005442 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5443 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5444 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005445 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005446
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005447 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5448 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5449 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5450
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005451 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005452 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005453
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005454 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5455 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5456 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5457
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005458 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005459
5460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005461redisp (deprecated)
5462redispatch (deprecated)
5463 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5464 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005466 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005467
5468 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5469 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5470 be able to access the service anymore.
5471
5472 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5473 redistribute them to a working server.
5474
5475 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5476 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5477 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005479 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5480 "option redispatch" instead.
5481
5482 See also : "option redispatch"
5483
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005484
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005485reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005486 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5488 no | yes | yes | yes
5489 Arguments :
5490 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5491 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005492 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005493
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005494 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5495 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5496
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005497 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5498 the last header of an HTTP request.
5499
5500 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5501 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5502 responses.
5503
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005504 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5505 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5506 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5507
5508 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5509 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005510
5511
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005512reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5513reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005514 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5516 no | yes | yes | yes
5517 Arguments :
5518 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5519 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5520 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5521 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5522 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5523 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5524 ignores case.
5525
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005526 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5527 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5528
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005529 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5530 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5531 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5532 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005533 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005534
5535 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5536 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5537
5538 Example :
5539 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5540 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5541 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5542
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005543 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5544 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005545
5546
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005547reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5548reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005549 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5551 no | yes | yes | yes
5552 Arguments :
5553 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5554 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5555 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5556 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5557 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5558 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5559
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005560 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5561 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5562
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005563 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5564 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5565 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5566 next servers.
5567
5568 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5569 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5570 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5571
5572 Example :
5573 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5574 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5575 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5576
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005577 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5578 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005579
5580
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005581reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5582reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005583 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5585 no | yes | yes | yes
5586 Arguments :
5587 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5588 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5589 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5590 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5591 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5592 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5593 case.
5594
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005595 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5596 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5597
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005598 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5599 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5600 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5601 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005602 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005603
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005604 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005605 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005606 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005607
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005608 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5609 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5610
5611 Example :
5612 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5613 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5614 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5615
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005616 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5617 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005618
5619
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005620reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5621reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005622 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5624 no | yes | yes | yes
5625 Arguments :
5626 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5627 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5628 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5629 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5630 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5631 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5632 case.
5633
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005634 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5635 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5636
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005637 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5638 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5639 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5640 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5641
5642 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5643 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5644
5645 Example :
5646 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5647 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5648 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5649 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5650
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005651 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5652 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005653
5654
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005655reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5656reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005657 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5659 no | yes | yes | yes
5660 Arguments :
5661 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5662 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5663 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5664 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5665 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5666 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5667
5668 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5669 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5670 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5671 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005672 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005673
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005674 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5675 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5676
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005677 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5678 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5679 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5680
5681 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5682 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5683 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5684 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5685 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5686
5687 Example :
5688 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005689 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005690 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5691 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5692
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005693 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5694 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005695
5696
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005697reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5698reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005699 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5701 no | yes | yes | yes
5702 Arguments :
5703 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5704 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5705 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5706 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5707 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5708 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5709 ignores case.
5710
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005711 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5712 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5713
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005714 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5715 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005716 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5717 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5718 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005719 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5720 not set.
5721
5722 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5723 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5724 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5725 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5726 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5727
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005728 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005729 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5730 # block all others.
5731 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5732 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5733
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005734 # block bad guys
5735 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5736 reqitarpit . if badguys
5737
5738 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5739 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005740
5741
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005742retries <value>
5743 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5745 yes | no | yes | yes
5746 Arguments :
5747 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5748 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5749 default value is 3.
5750
5751 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5752 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5753 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5754
5755 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5756 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5757
5758 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5759 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5760
5761 See also : "option redispatch"
5762
5763
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005764rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005765 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5767 no | yes | yes | yes
5768 Arguments :
5769 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5770 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005771 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005772
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005773 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5774 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5775
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005776 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5777 the last header of an HTTP response.
5778
5779 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5780 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5781 responses.
5782
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005783 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5784 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005785
5786
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005787rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5788rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005789 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5791 no | yes | yes | yes
5792 Arguments :
5793 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5794 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5795 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5796 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5797 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5798 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5799 ignores case.
5800
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005801 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5802 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5803
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005804 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5805 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005806 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005807 client.
5808
5809 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5810 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5811 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5812
5813 Example :
5814 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005815 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005816
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005817 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5818 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005819
5820
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005821rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5822rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005823 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5825 no | yes | yes | yes
5826 Arguments :
5827 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5828 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5829 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5830 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5831 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5832 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5833 ignores case.
5834
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005835 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5836 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5837
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005838 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5839 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5840 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5841 case-sensitive.
5842
5843 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005844 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5845 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5846 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005847
5848 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5849 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5850
5851 Example :
5852 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5853 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5854
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005855 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5856 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005857
5858
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005859rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5860rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005861 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5863 no | yes | yes | yes
5864 Arguments :
5865 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5866 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5867 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5868 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5869 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5870 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5871 ignores case.
5872
5873 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5874 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5875 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5876 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005877 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005878
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005879 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5880 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5881
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005882 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5883 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5884 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5885
5886 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5887 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5888 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5889 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5890 are not case-sensitive.
5891
5892 Example :
5893 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5894 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5895
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005896 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5897 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005898
5899
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005900server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005901 Declare a server in a backend
5902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5903 no | no | yes | yes
5904 Arguments :
5905 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005906 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005907 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005908
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005909 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5910 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5911 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5912 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005913 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5914 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5915 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5916 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5917 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005918 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5919 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5920 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5921 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5922 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5923 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5924 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005925 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005926 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5927 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5928 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5929 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005930
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005931 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005932 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5933 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5934 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5935 adding this value to the client's port.
5936
5937 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5938 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005939 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005940
5941 Examples :
5942 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5943 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005944 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005945 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5946 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5947 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005948
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005949 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5950 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005951
5952
5953source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005954source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005955source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005956 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5958 yes | no | yes | yes
5959 Arguments :
5960 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5961 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005962
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005963 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005964 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5965 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5966 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5967 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5968 supported prefixes are :
5969 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5970 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5971 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005972 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005973 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5974 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5975 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5976 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005977
5978 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5979 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005980 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5981 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5982 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005983
5984 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5985 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5986 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5987 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5988 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5989 <addr>.
5990
5991 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5992 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5993 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5994 port.
5995
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005996 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5997 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5998 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5999 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006000 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006001 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6002 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6003 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6004 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6005 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6006 HTTP header.
6007
6008 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6009 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006010 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006011 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6012 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6013 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6014 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6015 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6016 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6017 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6018
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006019 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6020 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6021 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6022 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6023 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6024 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6025
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006026 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6027 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6028 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6029 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6030
6031 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6032 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6033 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6034 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6035 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6036 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6037
6038 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6039 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6040 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6041 there are two methods :
6042
6043 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6044 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6045 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6046 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6047 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6048 of the client ranges may be used.
6049
6050 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6051 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6052 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6053 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6054 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6055 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6056 same session.
6057
6058 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6059 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6060 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6061 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6062 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6063 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6064
6065 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6066 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6067 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006068 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006069
6070 Examples :
6071 backend private
6072 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6073 source 192.168.1.200
6074
6075 backend transparent_ssl1
6076 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6077 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6078
6079 backend transparent_ssl2
6080 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6081 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6082 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6083
6084 backend transparent_ssl3
6085 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6086 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6087 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6088
6089 backend transparent_smtp
6090 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6091 # with Tproxy version 4.
6092 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6093
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006094 backend transparent_http
6095 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6096 # proxy.
6097 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006099 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006100 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6101
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006102
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006103srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6104 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6106 yes | no | yes | yes
6107 Arguments :
6108 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6109 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6110 as explained at the top of this document.
6111
6112 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6113 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6114 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6115 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6116 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6117 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6118 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6119
6120 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6121 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6122 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6123 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6124 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006125 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006126 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006127 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006128
6129 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6130 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6131 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6132 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6133 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6134 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6135
6136 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6137 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6138
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006139 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6140 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006141
6142
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006143stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6144 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006146 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006147
6148 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6149 matched.
6150
6151 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6152 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6153
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006154 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6155 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6156 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6157
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006158 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6159 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6160 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6161 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006162
6163 Example :
6164 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6165 backend stats_localhost
6166 stats enable
6167 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6168
6169 Example :
6170 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6171 backend stats_auth
6172 stats enable
6173 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6174 stats admin if TRUE
6175
6176 Example :
6177 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6178 userlist stats-auth
6179 group admin users admin
6180 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6181 group readonly users haproxy
6182 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6183
6184 backend stats_auth
6185 stats enable
6186 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6187 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6188 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6189 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6190
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006191 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6192 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6193 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006194
6195
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006196stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6197 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006199 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006200 Arguments :
6201 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6202
6203 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6204
6205 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6206 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6207 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6208 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6209 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6210 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6211
6212 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6213 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6214 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006215 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006216
6217 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6218 report using "stats scope".
6219
6220 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6221 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6222 unobvious parameters.
6223
6224 Example :
6225 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6226 backend public_www
6227 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6228 stats enable
6229 stats hide-version
6230 stats scope .
6231 stats uri /admin?stats
6232 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6233 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6234 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6235
6236 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6237 backend private_monitoring
6238 stats enable
6239 stats uri /admin?stats
6240 stats refresh 5s
6241
6242 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6243
6244
6245stats enable
6246 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006248 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006249 Arguments : none
6250
6251 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6252 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6253 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6254 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6255 - stats auth : no authentication
6256 - stats scope : no restriction
6257
6258 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6259 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6260 unobvious parameters.
6261
6262 Example :
6263 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6264 backend public_www
6265 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6266 stats enable
6267 stats hide-version
6268 stats scope .
6269 stats uri /admin?stats
6270 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6271 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6272 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6273
6274 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6275 backend private_monitoring
6276 stats enable
6277 stats uri /admin?stats
6278 stats refresh 5s
6279
6280 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6281
6282
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006283stats hide-version
6284 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006286 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006287 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006288
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006289 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6290 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6291 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6292 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6293 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6294 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006295
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006296 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6297 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6298 unobvious parameters.
6299
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006300 Example :
6301 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6302 backend public_www
6303 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006304 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006305 stats hide-version
6306 stats scope .
6307 stats uri /admin?stats
6308 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6309 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6310 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006311
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006312 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6313 backend private_monitoring
6314 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006315 stats uri /admin?stats
6316 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006317
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006318 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006319
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006320
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006321stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6322 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6323 Access control for statistics
6324
6325 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6326 no | no | yes | yes
6327
6328 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6329 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6330 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6331 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6332 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6333 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6334
6335 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6336 instance.
6337
6338 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6339 about ACL usage.
6340
6341
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006342stats realm <realm>
6343 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006345 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006346 Arguments :
6347 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6348 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6349 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6350
6351 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6352 using a backslash ('\').
6353
6354 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6355 only related to authentication.
6356
6357 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6358 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6359 unobvious parameters.
6360
6361 Example :
6362 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6363 backend public_www
6364 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6365 stats enable
6366 stats hide-version
6367 stats scope .
6368 stats uri /admin?stats
6369 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6370 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6371 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6372
6373 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6374 backend private_monitoring
6375 stats enable
6376 stats uri /admin?stats
6377 stats refresh 5s
6378
6379 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6380
6381
6382stats refresh <delay>
6383 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006385 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006386 Arguments :
6387 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6388 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6389 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6390 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6391 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6392 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6393
6394 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6395 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6396 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6397 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6398
6399 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6400 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6401 unobvious parameters.
6402
6403 Example :
6404 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6405 backend public_www
6406 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6407 stats enable
6408 stats hide-version
6409 stats scope .
6410 stats uri /admin?stats
6411 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6412 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6413 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6414
6415 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6416 backend private_monitoring
6417 stats enable
6418 stats uri /admin?stats
6419 stats refresh 5s
6420
6421 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6422
6423
6424stats scope { <name> | "." }
6425 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006427 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006428 Arguments :
6429 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6430 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6431 section in which the statement appears.
6432
6433 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6434 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6435 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6436 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6437 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6438 exists.
6439
6440 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6441 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6442 unobvious parameters.
6443
6444 Example :
6445 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6446 backend public_www
6447 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6448 stats enable
6449 stats hide-version
6450 stats scope .
6451 stats uri /admin?stats
6452 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6453 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6454 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6455
6456 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6457 backend private_monitoring
6458 stats enable
6459 stats uri /admin?stats
6460 stats refresh 5s
6461
6462 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6463
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006464
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006465stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006466 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006468 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006469
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006470 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006471 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6472
6473 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6474 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6475
6476 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6477 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006478 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006479
6480 Example :
6481 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6482 backend private_monitoring
6483 stats enable
6484 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6485 stats uri /admin?stats
6486 stats refresh 5s
6487
6488 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6489 global section.
6490
6491
6492stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006493 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6495 yes | yes | yes | yes
6496 Arguments : none
6497
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006498 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006499 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6500 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6501 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6502 - IP (socket, server)
6503 - cookie (backend, server)
6504
6505 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6506 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006507 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006508
6509 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6510
6511
6512stats show-node [ <name> ]
6513 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006515 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006516 Arguments:
6517 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6518 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6519
6520 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6521 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006522 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006523
6524 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6525 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6526 unobvious parameters.
6527
6528 Example:
6529 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6530 backend private_monitoring
6531 stats enable
6532 stats show-node Europe-1
6533 stats uri /admin?stats
6534 stats refresh 5s
6535
6536 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6537 section.
6538
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006539
6540stats uri <prefix>
6541 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006543 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006544 Arguments :
6545 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6546 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6547 query string.
6548
6549 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6550 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6551 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6552 possible to reach it in the application.
6553
6554 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006555 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006556 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6557 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6558 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6559 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6560
6561 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6562 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6563 an address or a port to statistics only.
6564
6565 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6566 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6567 unobvious parameters.
6568
6569 Example :
6570 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6571 backend public_www
6572 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6573 stats enable
6574 stats hide-version
6575 stats scope .
6576 stats uri /admin?stats
6577 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6578 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6579 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6580
6581 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6582 backend private_monitoring
6583 stats enable
6584 stats uri /admin?stats
6585 stats refresh 5s
6586
6587 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6588
6589
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006590stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6591 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006593 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006594
6595 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006596 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006597 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6598 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6599 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6600
6601 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6602 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6603 the "stick-table" statement.
6604
6605 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6606 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6607 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6608 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6609 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6610
6611 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6612 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6613 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6614 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6615 transformation rules.
6616
6617 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6618 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6619 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6620 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6621 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6622 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6623 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6624
6625 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6626 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6627 ACL based conditions.
6628
6629 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6630 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6631 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6632 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6633
6634 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6635 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6636 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6637 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6638
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006639 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6640 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6641 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6642
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006643 Example :
6644 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6645 # last 30 minutes
6646 backend pop
6647 mode tcp
6648 balance roundrobin
6649 stick store-request src
6650 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6651 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6652 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6653
6654 backend smtp
6655 mode tcp
6656 balance roundrobin
6657 stick match src table pop
6658 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6659 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6660
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006661 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006662 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006663
6664
6665stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6666 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6668 no | no | yes | yes
6669
6670 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6671 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6672 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6673 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6674
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006675 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6676 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6677 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6678
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006679 Examples :
6680 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006681 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006682
6683 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6684 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6685 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6686
6687
6688 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6689 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6690 backend http
6691 mode http
6692 balance roundrobin
6693 stick on src table https
6694 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6695 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6696 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6697
6698 backend https
6699 mode tcp
6700 balance roundrobin
6701 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6702 stick on src
6703 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6704 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6705
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006706 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006707
6708
6709stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6710 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6712 no | no | yes | yes
6713
6714 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006715 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006716 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6717 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6718 server is selected.
6719
6720 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6721 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6722 the "stick-table" statement.
6723
6724 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6725 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6726 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6727 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6728 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6729 address.
6730
6731 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6732 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6733 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6734 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6735 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6736 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6737 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6738 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6739 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6740 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6741
6742 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6743 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6744 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6745 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6746 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6747 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6748 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6749
6750 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6751 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6752 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6753 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6754
6755 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6756 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6757 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6758 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6759 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6760 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006761 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6762 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6763 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6764 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6765 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6766 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006767
6768 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6769 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6770 the request.
6771
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006772 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6773 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6774 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6775
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006776 Example :
6777 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6778 # last 30 minutes
6779 backend pop
6780 mode tcp
6781 balance roundrobin
6782 stick store-request src
6783 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6784 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6785 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6786
6787 backend smtp
6788 mode tcp
6789 balance roundrobin
6790 stick match src table pop
6791 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6792 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6793
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006794 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006795 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006796
6797
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006798stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006799 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6800 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006801 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006803 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006804
6805 Arguments :
6806 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6807 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6808 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6809 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6810
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006811 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6812 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6813 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6814 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6815
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006816 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6817 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6818 instance.
6819
6820 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6821 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6822 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6823 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6824 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6825 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006826 to 32 characters.
6827
6828 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6829 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6830 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006831 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006832 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6833 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006834
6835 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006836 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6837 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006838 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6839 increase.
6840
6841 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006842 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6843 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6844 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006845
6846 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6847 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6848 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6849 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6850 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6851 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6852 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6853 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6854 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6855 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6856 parameter (see below).
6857
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006858 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6859 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6860 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6861 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6862 soft restart.
6863
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006864 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6865
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006866 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6867 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6868 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6869 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6870 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006871 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006872 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6873 if not expiration delay is specified.
6874
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006875 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6876 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6877 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6878 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006879 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6880 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6881 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6882 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6883 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6884 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6885 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6886 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6887 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6888 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6889 types and their arguments.
6890
6891 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6892 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6893 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6894 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6895
6896 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6897 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6898 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6899 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6900
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006901 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6902 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6903 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6904 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6905 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6906 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6907
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006908 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6909 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6910 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6911 they were received.
6912
6913 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6914 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6915 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6916 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6917 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6918
6919 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6920 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6921 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6922 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6923 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6924
6925 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6926 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6927 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6928
6929 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6930 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6931 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6932 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6933 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6934
6935 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6936 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6937 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6938 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6939 the client side.
6940
6941 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6942 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6943 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6944 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6945 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6946 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6947 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6948
6949 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6950 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6951 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6952 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6953 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6954 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6955 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6956
6957 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6958 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6959 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6960 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6961 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6962 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6963
6964 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6965 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6966 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6967 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6968
6969 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6970 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6971 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6972 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6973 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6974 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6975 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6976 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6977 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6978 recommended for better fairness.
6979
6980 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6981 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6982 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6983 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6984
6985 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6986 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6987 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6988 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6989 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6990 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6991 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6992 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6993 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6994 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006995
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006996 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6997 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006998 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6999 reference it.
7000
7001 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7002 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7003 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7004 as an exclusive stickiness.
7005
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007006 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7007 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7008 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7009 something that can be ignored.
7010
7011 Example:
7012 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7013 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7014 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7015 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7016
7017 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007018 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007019
7020
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007021stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7022 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7024 no | no | yes | yes
7025
7026 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007027 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007028 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7029 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7030 server is selected.
7031
7032 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7033 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7034 the "stick-table" statement.
7035
7036 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7037 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7038 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7039 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7040
7041 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7042 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7043 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7044 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7045 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7046 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007047 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007048 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7049 rules.
7050
7051 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7052 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7053 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7054 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7055 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7056 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7057 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7058
7059 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7060 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7061 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7062 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7063
7064 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7065 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7066 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7067 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7068 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7069 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007070 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7071 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7072 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7073 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7074 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7075 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7076 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7077 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7078 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007079
7080 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7081
7082 Example :
7083 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7084 backend https
7085 mode tcp
7086 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007087 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007088 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007089
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007090 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7091 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7092
7093 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7094 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7095 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7096
7097 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7098 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007099
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007100 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7101 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7102 # at offset 44.
7103
7104 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7105 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7106
7107 # Learn on response if server hello.
7108 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007109
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007110 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7111 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7112
7113 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7114 extraction.
7115
7116
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007117tcp-check connect [params*]
7118 Opens a new connection
7119 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7120 no | no | yes | yes
7121
7122 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7123 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7124 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7125
7126 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7127 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7128 of the sequence.
7129
7130 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7131 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7132 do.
7133
7134 Parameters :
7135 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7136 use the TCP connection.
7137
7138 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7139 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7140 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7141
7142 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7143
7144 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7145
7146 Examples:
7147 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7148 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7149 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7150 option tcp-check
7151 tcp-check connect
7152 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7153 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7154 tcp-check send \r\n
7155 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7156 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7157 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7158 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7159 tcp-check send \r\n
7160 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7161 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7162
7163 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7164 option tcp-check
7165 tcp-check connect port 110
7166 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7167 tcp-check connect port 143
7168 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7169 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7170
7171 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7172
7173
7174tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7175 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7176 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7177 no | no | yes | yes
7178
7179 Arguments :
7180 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7181 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7182 binary.
7183 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7184 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7185 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7186
7187 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7188 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7189 with the usual backslash ('\').
7190 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7191 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7192 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7193 used upper or lower case.
7194
7195
7196 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7197
7198 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7199 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7200 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7201 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7202 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7203 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7204 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7205 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7206
7207 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7208 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7209 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7210 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7211 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7212 expression.
7213
7214 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7215 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7216 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7217 this exact hexadecimal string.
7218 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7219
7220 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7221 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7222 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7223 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7224 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7225 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7226 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7227 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7228 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7229 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7230 the null character.
7231
7232 Examples :
7233 # perform a POP check
7234 option tcp-check
7235 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7236
7237 # perform an IMAP check
7238 option tcp-check
7239 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7240
7241 # look for the redis master server
7242 option tcp-check
7243 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7244 tcp-check expect +PONG
7245 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7246 tcp-check expect string role:master
7247 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7248 tcp-check expect string +OK
7249
7250
7251 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7252 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7253
7254
7255tcp-check send <data>
7256 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7257 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7258 no | no | yes | yes
7259
7260 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7261 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7262
7263 Examples :
7264 # look for the redis master server
7265 option tcp-check
7266 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7267 tcp-check expect string role:master
7268
7269 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7270 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7271
7272
7273tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7274 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7275 tcp health check
7276 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7277 no | no | yes | yes
7278
7279 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7280 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7281 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7282 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7283 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7284 hexadecimal string.
7285 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7286
7287 Examples :
7288 # redis check in binary
7289 option tcp-check
7290 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7291 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7292
7293
7294 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7295 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7296
7297
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007298tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7299 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7301 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007302 Arguments :
7303 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007304 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7305 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007306
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007307 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007308
7309 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7310 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007311 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7312 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7313 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7314 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7315 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7316 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007317
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007318 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7319 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7320 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7321 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007322
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007323 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007324 - accept :
7325 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7326 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7327 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007328
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007329 - reject :
7330 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7331 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7332 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7333 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7334 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7335 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7336 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7337 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7338 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7339 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7340 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7341 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007342
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007343 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7344 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7345 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7346 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7347 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7348 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7349 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7350 hosts.
7351
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007352 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7353 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7354 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7355 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7356 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7357 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7358 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7359 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7360 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7361 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7362 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7363
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007364 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007365 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7366 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7367 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007368 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7369 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007370 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007371 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7372 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7373 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7374 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7375 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007376
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007377 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007378 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007379 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007380 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7381 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7382 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7383 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007384
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007385 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7386 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7387 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7388 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007389
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007390 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7391 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7392 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7393 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7394 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007395 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7396 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7397 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7398 layer7 information is extracted.
7399
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007400 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7401 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7402 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7403 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7404 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007405
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007406 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7407 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7408 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007409
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007410 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7411 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7412 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007413
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007414 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007415 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007416 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007417
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007418 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7419 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7420 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007421
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007422 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007423 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7424 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007425
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007426 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7427
7428 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7429
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007430 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7431
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007432 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007433
7434
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007435tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7436 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007438 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007439 Arguments :
7440 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007441 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007442 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7443 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007444
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007445 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007446
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007447 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7448 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7449 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7450 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7451 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007452
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007453 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7454 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7455 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7456 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007457 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7458 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7459 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7460 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7461 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7462 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007463 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007464 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007465
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007466 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7467 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7468 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7469 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007470
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007471 Four types of actions are supported :
7472 - accept : the request is accepted
7473 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7474 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007475 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007476
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007477 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7478 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007479
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007480 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7481 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7482 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7483 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7484 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7485 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007487 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007488 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7489 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007490
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007491 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007492 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7493 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7494 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7495 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007496 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7497 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7498 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007499
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007500 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007501 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7502 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7503 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007504
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007505 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007506 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7507 # and reject everything else.
7508 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7509 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007510 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007511 tcp-request content reject
7512
7513 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007514 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7515 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7516 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007517 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007518
7519 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7520 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7521 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007522 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007523 tcp-request content reject
7524
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007525 Example:
7526 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7527 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007528 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007529
7530 Example:
7531 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7532 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau531485c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007533 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007534
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007535 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7536 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7537
7538 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007539 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007540 # protecting all our sites
7541 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007542 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7543 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007544 ...
7545 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7546
7547 backend http_dynamic
7548 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007549 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007550 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007551 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7552 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7553 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007554 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007556 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007557
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007558 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007559
7560
7561tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7562 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007564 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007565 Arguments :
7566 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7567 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7568 as explained at the top of this document.
7569
7570 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7571 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7572 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7573 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7574 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7575
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007576 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7577 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7578 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7579 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7580
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007581 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7582 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007583 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007584 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007585 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7586 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7587 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7588 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007589
7590 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7591 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7592 it pass through unaffected.
7593
7594 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7595 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7596 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007597 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007598 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7599 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007600 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7601 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7602 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007603
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007604 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007605 "timeout client".
7606
7607
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007608tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7609 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7611 no | no | yes | yes
7612 Arguments :
7613 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007614 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007615
7616 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7617
7618 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7619 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7620 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007621 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7622 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007623
7624 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7625
7626 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7627 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7628 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7629 inserted.
7630
7631 Two types of actions are supported :
7632 - accept :
7633 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7634 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7635 the rules evaluation.
7636
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007637 - close :
7638 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7639 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7640 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7641 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7642 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7643 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007644 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007645 protocols.
7646
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007647 - reject :
7648 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7649 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007650 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007651
7652 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7653 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7654 for changing the default action to a reject.
7655
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007656 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7657 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7658 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7659 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007660 period.
7661
7662 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7663
7664 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7665
7666
7667tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7668 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7670 no | no | yes | yes
7671 Arguments :
7672 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7673 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7674 as explained at the top of this document.
7675
7676 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7677
7678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007679timeout check <timeout>
7680 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7681 established.
7682
7683 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7684 yes | no | yes | yes
7685 Arguments:
7686 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7687 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7688 as explained at the top of this document.
7689
7690 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7691 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7692 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7693 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007694 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7695 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7696 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007697
7698 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7699 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7700
7701 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7702 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007703 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007704
7705 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7706 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7707 forget about it.
7708
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007709 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7710 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007711
7712
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007713timeout client <timeout>
7714timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7715 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7717 yes | yes | yes | no
7718 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007719 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007720 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7721 as explained at the top of this document.
7722
7723 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7724 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7725 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7726 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7727 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7728 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7729 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7730 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007731 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007732 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007733 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7734 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007735 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7736 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007737
7738 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7739 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7740 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7741 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7742 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7743 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7744
7745 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7746 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7747 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7748
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007749 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007750
7751
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007752timeout client-fin <timeout>
7753 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7755 yes | yes | yes | no
7756 Arguments :
7757 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7758 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7759 as explained at the top of this document.
7760
7761 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7762 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7763 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7764 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7765 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7766 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7767 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7768 down in one direction.
7769
7770 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7771 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7772 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7773
7774 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7775
7776
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007777timeout connect <timeout>
7778timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7779 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7781 yes | no | yes | yes
7782 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007783 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007784 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7785 as explained at the top of this document.
7786
7787 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007788 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007789 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007790 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007791 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7792 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007793
7794 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7795 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7796 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7797 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7798 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7799 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7800
7801 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7802 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7803 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7804
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007805 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7806 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007807
7808
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007809timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7810 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7812 yes | yes | yes | yes
7813 Arguments :
7814 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7815 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7816 as explained at the top of this document.
7817
7818 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7819 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7820 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7821 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7822 once the request has started to present itself.
7823
7824 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7825 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7826 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7827 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7828 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7829
7830 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7831 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7832 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7833 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7834
7835 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7836 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7837 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7838 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7839 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007840 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007841
7842 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7843 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7844 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7845 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7846
7847 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7848
7849
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007850timeout http-request <timeout>
7851 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007853 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007854 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007855 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007856 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7857 as explained at the top of this document.
7858
7859 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7860 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7861 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7862 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7863 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7864 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7865 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007866 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7867 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7868 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7869 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7870 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7871 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7872 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007873
7874 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7875 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007876 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7877 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007878
7879 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7880 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7881 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7882 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7883 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7884
7885 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007886 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7887 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7888 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007889
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007890 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007891
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007892
7893timeout queue <timeout>
7894 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7896 yes | no | yes | yes
7897 Arguments :
7898 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7899 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7900 as explained at the top of this document.
7901
7902 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7903 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7904 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7905 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7906 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7907
7908 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7909 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7910 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7911 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7912
7913 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7914
7915
7916timeout server <timeout>
7917timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7918 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7920 yes | no | yes | yes
7921 Arguments :
7922 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7923 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7924 as explained at the top of this document.
7925
7926 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7927 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7928 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7929 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7930 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7931 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7932 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7933
7934 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7935 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7936 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7937 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7938 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007939 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007940 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007941 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7942 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7943 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7944 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007945
7946 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7947 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7948 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7949 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7950 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7951 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7952
7953 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7954 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7955 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7956
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007957 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007958
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007959
7960timeout server-fin <timeout>
7961 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7963 yes | no | yes | yes
7964 Arguments :
7965 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7966 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7967 as explained at the top of this document.
7968
7969 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7970 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7971 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7972 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7973 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
7974 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7975 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7976 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
7977 situations, it should not be needed.
7978
7979 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7980 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7981 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
7982
7983 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
7984
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007985
7986timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007987 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7989 yes | yes | yes | yes
7990 Arguments :
7991 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7992 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7993 as explained at the top of this document.
7994
7995 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7996 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7997 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7998
7999 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8000 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8001 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8002 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008003 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008004
8005 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8006
8007
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008008timeout tunnel <timeout>
8009 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8011 yes | no | yes | yes
8012 Arguments :
8013 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8014 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8015 as explained at the top of this document.
8016
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008017 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008018 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8019 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8020 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8021 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8022 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8023 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8024 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8025 specified.
8026
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008027 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8028 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8029 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8030 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8031 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8032 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8033 state.
8034
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008035 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8036 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8037 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8038 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8039 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8040
8041 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8042 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8043 forget about it.
8044
8045 Example :
8046 defaults http
8047 option http-server-close
8048 timeout connect 5s
8049 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008050 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008051 timeout server 30s
8052 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8053
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008054 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008055
8056
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008057transparent (deprecated)
8058 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008060 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008061 Arguments : none
8062
8063 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8064 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8065 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8066 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8067 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8068 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8069 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8070 appropriate server.
8071
8072 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8073
8074 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8075 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8076
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008077 See also: "option transparent"
8078
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008079unique-id-format <string>
8080 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8082 yes | yes | yes | no
8083 Arguments :
8084 <string> is a log-format string.
8085
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008086 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8087 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8088 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8089 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008090
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008091 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8092 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8093 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8094 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8095 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8096 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8097 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8098 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008099
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008100 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8101 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008102
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008103 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008104
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008105 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008106
8107 will generate:
8108
8109 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8110
8111 See also: "unique-id-header"
8112
8113unique-id-header <name>
8114 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8116 yes | yes | yes | no
8117 Arguments :
8118 <name> is the name of the header.
8119
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008120 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8121 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008122
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008123 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008124
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008125 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008126 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8127
8128 will generate:
8129
8130 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8131
8132 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008133
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008134use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008135 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8137 no | yes | yes | no
8138 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008139 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8140 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008141
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008142 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8143 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008144
8145 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8146 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8147 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008148 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8149 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8150 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8151 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008152
8153 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8154 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8155 assign the backend.
8156
8157 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8158 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8159 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8160 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8161 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8162 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8163
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008164 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008165 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008166 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8167 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8168 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8169
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008170 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8171 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8172 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8173 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8174 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8175 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8176 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8177 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8178 cannot be forced from the request.
8179
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008180 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008181 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8182 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8183
8184 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8185 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008186
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008187
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008188use-server <server> if <condition>
8189use-server <server> unless <condition>
8190 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8192 no | no | yes | yes
8193 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008194 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008195
8196 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8197
8198 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8199 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8200 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8201
8202 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8203 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8204 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8205 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8206 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8207 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8208 matches will assign the server.
8209
8210 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8211 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8212 with the next rules until one matches.
8213
8214 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8215 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8216 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8217 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8218
8219 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8220 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8221 stripped.
8222
8223 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8224 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8225 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8226 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8227
8228 Example :
8229 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8230 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8231 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8232 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8233 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8234 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8235 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8236 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8237 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8238
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008239 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008240
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008241
82425. Bind and Server options
8243--------------------------
8244
8245The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8246depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8247settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8248written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8249described in this section.
8250
8251
82525.1. Bind options
8253-----------------
8254
8255The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8256as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8257no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8258parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8259while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8260provided immediately after the setting name.
8261
8262The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8263
8264accept-proxy
8265 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008266 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8267 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008268 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8269 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8270 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8271 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8272 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8273 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8274 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008275 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8276 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008277
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008278alpn <protocols>
8279 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8280 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8281 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8282 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8283 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8284 initial NPN extension.
8285
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008286backlog <backlog>
8287 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8288 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8289
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008290ecdhe <named curve>
8291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008292 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8293 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008294
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008295ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8297 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8298 client's certificate.
8299
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008300ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8301 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8302 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8303 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8304 error is ignored.
8305
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008306ciphers <ciphers>
8307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8308 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008309 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008310 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8311 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8312
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008313crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008314 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8315 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8316 to verify client's certificate.
8317
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008318crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008319 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8320 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8321 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8322 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8323 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8324 file.
8325
8326 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8327 are loaded.
8328
8329 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté62043c92015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008330 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
8331 '.issuer' or '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified
8332 multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8333 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
8334 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects.
8335 Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the
8336 first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008337 www.sub.example.org).
8338
8339 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8340 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8341 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8342 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté62043c92015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008343 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8344 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008345
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008346 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008347
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008348 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8349 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008350 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008351 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8352 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8353 clients).
8354
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008355 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8356 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8357 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8358 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8359 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8360 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8361 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8362 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8363 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8364 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8365 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8366 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8367 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8368
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008369crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008370 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8371 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008372 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008373 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008374
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008375crt-list <file>
8376 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008377 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8378 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008379
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008380 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008381
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008382 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8383 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8384 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8385 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8386 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8387 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8388 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8389 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008390
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008391defer-accept
8392 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8393 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8394 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8395 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8396 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8397 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8398 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8399 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8400 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8401 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8402 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8403
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008404force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008405 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008406 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008407 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8408 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008409
8410force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008411 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008412 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8413 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008414
8415force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008416 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008417 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8418 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008419
8420force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008421 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008422 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8423 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008424
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008425gid <gid>
8426 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8427 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8428 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8429 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8430 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8431
8432group <group>
8433 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8434 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8435 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8436 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8437 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8438
8439id <id>
8440 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8441 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8442 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8443 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8444
8445interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008446 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8447 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8448 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8449 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8450 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8451 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8452 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008453
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008454level <level>
8455 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8456 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8457 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8458 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8459 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8460 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8461 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8462 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8463 counters).
8464 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8465 all counters).
8466
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008467maxconn <maxconn>
8468 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8469 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8470 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8471 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8472 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8473 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8474 eat all memory.
8475
8476mode <mode>
8477 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8478 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8479 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8480 UNIX sockets.
8481
8482mss <maxseg>
8483 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8484 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8485 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8486 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8487 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8488 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8489 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8490 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8491 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8492 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8493 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8494
8495name <name>
8496 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8497 page.
8498
8499nice <nice>
8500 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8501 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8502 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8503 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8504 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8505 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8506 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8507 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8508 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8509 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8510 one for an RDP socket.
8511
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008512no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008513 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008514 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008515 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008516 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8517 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008518 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008519
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008520no-tls-tickets
8521 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8522 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8523 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008524 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8525 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008526
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008527no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008528 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008529 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008530 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008531 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8532 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8533 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008534
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008535no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008536 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008537 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008538 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008539 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8540 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8541 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008542
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008543no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008544 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008545 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008546 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008547 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8548 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8549 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008550
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008551npn <protocols>
8552 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8553 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8554 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8555 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008556 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8557 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008558
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008559process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8560 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8561 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8562 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8563 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8564 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8565 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8566 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008567 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8568 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8569 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8570 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8571 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8572 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8573 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008574
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008575ssl
8576 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008577 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008578 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8579 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8580 to deciphered contents.
8581
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008582strict-sni
8583 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8584 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8585 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8586 See the "crt" option for more information.
8587
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008588tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008589 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008590 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8591 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8592 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8593 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8594 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8595 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8596 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008597 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8598 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8599 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008600
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008601transparent
8602 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8603 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8604 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8605 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8606 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8607 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8608 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8609 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8610 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8611 so check for support with your vendor.
8612
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008613v4v6
8614 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8615 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8616 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8617 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008618 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008619
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008620v6only
8621 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8622 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8623 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008624 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8625 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008626
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008627uid <uid>
8628 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8629 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8630 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8631 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8632 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8633
8634user <user>
8635 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8636 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8637 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8638 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8639 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8640
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008641verify [none|optional|required]
8642 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8643 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8644 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8645 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8646 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008647 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8648 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8649 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8650 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008651
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020086525.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008653------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008655The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8656which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8657arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8658settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8659after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8660Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8661address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008663 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008664 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008666The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008667
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008668addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008669 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8670 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8671 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8672 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8673 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008674
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008675 Supported in default-server: No
8676
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008677agent-check
8678 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008679 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8680 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8681 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8682 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008683
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008684 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008685 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreau47067ca2014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008686 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8687 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8688 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008689
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008690 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8691 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008692
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008693 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8694 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8695 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008696
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008697 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8698 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8699 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008700
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008701 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8702 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8703 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8704 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8705 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8706 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8707 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008708
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008709 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8710 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008711
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008712 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8713 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8714 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8715 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8716 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8717 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8718 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8719 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8720 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008721
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008722 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8723 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008724 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8725 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8726 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8727 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008728
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008729 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8730 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008731
8732 Supported in default-server: No
8733
8734agent-inter <delay>
8735 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8736 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8737
8738 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8739 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8740 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8741 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8742 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8743 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8744 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8745 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8746 of backends use the same servers.
8747
8748 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8749
8750 Supported in default-server: Yes
8751
8752agent-port <port>
8753 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8754
8755 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8756
8757 Supported in default-server: Yes
8758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008759backup
8760 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8761 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8762 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8763 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8764 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8765 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008767 Supported in default-server: No
8768
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008769ca-file <cafile>
8770 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8771 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8772 server's certificate.
8773
8774 Supported in default-server: No
8775
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008776check
8777 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008778 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8779 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8780 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8781 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8782 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8783 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8784 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008785 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8786 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8787 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008788
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008789 Supported in default-server: No
8790
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008791check-send-proxy
8792 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8793 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8794 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8795 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8796 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8797 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8798 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8799
8800 Supported in default-server: No
8801
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008802check-ssl
8803 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8804 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8805 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8806 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008807 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008808 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8809 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8810 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8811 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8812
8813 Supported in default-server: No
8814
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008815ciphers <ciphers>
8816 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008817 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008818 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8819 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8820 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8821 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8822 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8823 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8824
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008825 Supported in default-server: No
8826
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008827cookie <value>
8828 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8829 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8830 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8831 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8832 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8833 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8834 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008836 Supported in default-server: No
8837
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008838crl-file <crlfile>
8839 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8840 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8841 to verify server's certificate.
8842
8843 Supported in default-server: No
8844
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008845crt <cert>
8846 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8847 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8848 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8849 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8850 certificate request.
8851
8852 Supported in default-server: No
8853
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008854disabled
8855 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8856 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8857 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8858 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8859 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8860
8861 Supported in default-server: No
8862
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008863error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008864 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8865 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8866 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008867
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008868 Supported in default-server: Yes
8869
8870 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008871
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008872fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008873 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8874 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8875 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8876
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008877 Supported in default-server: Yes
8878
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008879force-sslv3
8880 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8881 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008882 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8883 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008884
8885 Supported in default-server: No
8886
8887force-tlsv10
8888 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008889 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8890 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008891
8892 Supported in default-server: No
8893
8894force-tlsv11
8895 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008896 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8897 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008898
8899 Supported in default-server: No
8900
8901force-tlsv12
8902 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008903 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8904 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008905
8906 Supported in default-server: No
8907
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008908id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008909 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8910 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8911 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008913 Supported in default-server: No
8914
8915inter <delay>
8916fastinter <delay>
8917downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008918 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8919 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8920 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8921 between checks depending on the server state :
8922
8923 Server state | Interval used
8924 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8925 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8926 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8927 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8928 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8929 or yet unchecked. |
8930 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8931 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8932 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008934 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8935 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8936 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8937 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008938 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8939 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8940 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8941 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8942 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008944 Supported in default-server: Yes
8945
8946maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008947 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8948 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8949 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8950 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8951 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8952 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8953 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8954 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008956 Supported in default-server: Yes
8957
8958maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008959 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8960 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8961 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8962 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8963 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8964 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8965 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8966
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008967 Supported in default-server: Yes
8968
8969minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008970 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8971 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8972 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8973 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8974 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8975 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008976 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008977 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008978
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008979 Supported in default-server: Yes
8980
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008981no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008982 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8983 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008984 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008985
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008986 Supported in default-server: No
8987
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008988no-tls-tickets
8989 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8990 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8991 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008992 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
8993 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008994
8995 Supported in default-server: No
8996
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008997no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008998 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008999 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9000 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009001 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9002 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9003 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009004
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009005 Supported in default-server: No
9006
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009007no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009008 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009009 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9010 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009011 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9012 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9013 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009014
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009015 Supported in default-server: No
9016
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009017no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009018 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009019 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9020 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun42a3e202014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009021 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9022 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9023 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009024
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009025 Supported in default-server: No
9026
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009027non-stick
9028 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9029 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9030 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9031
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009032 Supported in default-server: No
9033
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009034observe <mode>
9035 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9036 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9037 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9038 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9039 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9040 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009041 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009042
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009043 Supported in default-server: No
9044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009045 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009047on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009048 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9049 Currently, four modes are available:
9050 - fastinter: force fastinter
9051 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9052 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9053 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9054 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009056 Supported in default-server: Yes
9057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009058 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9059
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009060on-marked-down <action>
9061 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9062 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009063 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9064 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9065 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9066 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9067 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9068 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9069 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9070 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009071
9072 Actions are disabled by default
9073
9074 Supported in default-server: Yes
9075
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009076on-marked-up <action>
9077 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9078 Currently one action is available:
9079 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9080 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9081 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9082 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9083 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9084 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9085 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9086 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9087
9088 Actions are disabled by default
9089
9090 Supported in default-server: Yes
9091
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009092port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009093 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9094 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9095 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9096 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9097 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9098 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9099
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009100 Supported in default-server: Yes
9101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009102redir <prefix>
9103 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9104 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9105 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9106 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9107 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9108 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9109 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9110 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009111 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009112 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9113 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9114 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9115 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9116 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9117
9118 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009120 Supported in default-server: No
9121
9122rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009123 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9124 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9125 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009127 Supported in default-server: Yes
9128
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009129send-proxy
9130 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9131 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9132 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9133 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9134 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9135 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9136 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9137 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9138 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009139 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9140 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9141 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9142 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9143 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009144
9145 Supported in default-server: No
9146
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009147send-proxy-v2
9148 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9149 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9150 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9151 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9152 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9153 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9154 option of the "bind" keyword.
9155
9156 Supported in default-server: No
9157
9158send-proxy-v2-ssl
9159 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9160 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9161 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9162 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9163 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9164 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9165 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9166 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9167
9168 Supported in default-server: No
9169
9170send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9171 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9172 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9173 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9174 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9175 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9176 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9177 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9178 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9179 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9180
9181 Supported in default-server: No
9182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009183slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009184 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9185 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9186 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9187 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9188 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9189 parameters :
9190
9191 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9192 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9193
9194 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9195 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9196 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9197 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9198
9199 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9200 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9201 seen as failed.
9202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009203 Supported in default-server: Yes
9204
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009205source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009206source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009207source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009208 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9209 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9210 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9211 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9212
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009213 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9214 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9215 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9216 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9217 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9218 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9219 server.
9220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009221 Supported in default-server: No
9222
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009223ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009224 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9225 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9226 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9227 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9228 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9229 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009230 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009231
9232 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009234track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009235 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9236 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9237 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9238 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009239 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9240
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009241 Supported in default-server: No
9242
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009243verify [none|required]
9244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009245 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9246 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9247 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9248 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009249 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9250 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9251 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009252
9253 Supported in default-server: No
9254
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009255verifyhost <hostname>
9256 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9257 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9258 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9259 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9260 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9261 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9262
9263 Supported in default-server: No
9264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009265weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009266 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9267 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9268 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009269 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9270 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9271 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9272 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9273 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9274 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009275
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009276 Supported in default-server: Yes
9277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009278
92796. HTTP header manipulation
9280---------------------------
9281
9282In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9283response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9284request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9285which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009286against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009287
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009288If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9289to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9290but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9291HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9292stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9293because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9294a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9295still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009297This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9298in section 4.2 :
9299
9300 - reqadd <string>
9301 - reqallow <search>
9302 - reqiallow <search>
9303 - reqdel <search>
9304 - reqidel <search>
9305 - reqdeny <search>
9306 - reqideny <search>
9307 - reqpass <search>
9308 - reqipass <search>
9309 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9310 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9311 - reqtarpit <search>
9312 - reqitarpit <search>
9313 - rspadd <string>
9314 - rspdel <search>
9315 - rspidel <search>
9316 - rspdeny <search>
9317 - rspideny <search>
9318 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9319 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9320
9321With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9322is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9323parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9324prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9325Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9326
9327 \t for a tab
9328 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9329 \n for a new line (LF)
9330 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9331 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9332 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9333 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9334 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9335
9336The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9337portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9338above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9339regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
93409 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9341is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9342
9343The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9344after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9345
9346Notes related to these keywords :
9347---------------------------------
9348 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9349 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9350 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9351
9352 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9353 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9354 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9355
9356 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9357 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9358 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9359 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9360 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9361
9362 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9363 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9364 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9365 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9366 useless headers before adding new ones.
9367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009368 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009369 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9370
9371 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9372 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9373 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9374
9375 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9376 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009377 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009378
9379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020093807. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9381----------------------------------
9382
9383Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9384client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9385The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9386these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9387but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9388data called patterns.
9389
9390
93917.1. ACL basics
9392---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009393
9394The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9395content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9396from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9397simple :
9398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009399 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009400 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009401 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9402 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009404The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9405adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009406
9407In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009409 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009410
9411This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9412Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9413and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009414an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9415conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9416as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9417are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009418
9419ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9420'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9421which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9422
9423There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9424performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009426The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9427specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9428this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009429methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9430ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009431
9432Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9433 - boolean
9434 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9435 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9436 - string
9437 - data block
9438
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009439Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9440converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9441would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9442The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9443which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9444
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009445Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9446keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9447fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9448which are summarized in the table below :
9449
9450 +---------------------+-----------------+
9451 | Sample or converter | Default |
9452 | output type | matching method |
9453 +---------------------+-----------------+
9454 | boolean | bool |
9455 +---------------------+-----------------+
9456 | integer | int |
9457 +---------------------+-----------------+
9458 | ip | ip |
9459 +---------------------+-----------------+
9460 | string | str |
9461 +---------------------+-----------------+
9462 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9463 +---------------------+-----------------+
9464
9465Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9466matching method, see below.
9467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009468The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9469 - boolean
9470 - integer or integer range
9471 - IP address / network
9472 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9473 - regular expression
9474 - hex block
9475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009476The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9477
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009478 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9479 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009480 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009481 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009482 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009483 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009484 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009486The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9487read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9488if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9489lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9490will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9491beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9492a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9493lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9494exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9495
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009496The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9497parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9498ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9499a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9500check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9501
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009502The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9503socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9504file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009506Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9507loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9508
9509 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9510
9511In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9512the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9513case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9514as well.
9515
9516The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9517sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9518do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9519methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9520is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9521obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9522followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9523default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9524that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9525string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9526
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009527The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9528By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9529string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9530resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9531server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9532waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9533flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9534function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009536There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9537sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9538be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009539
9540 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9541 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009542 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9543 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9544 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9545 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009546
9547 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9548 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009549 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009550
9551 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009552 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009553
9554 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009555 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009556
9557 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9558 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9559
9560 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9561 binary or string samples.
9562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009563 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9564 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009566 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9567 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9568 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009570 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9571 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009573 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9574 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009576 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9577 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009579 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9580 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009581 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009583 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9584 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9585 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009586
9587For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9588request, it is possible to do :
9589
9590 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9591
9592In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9593buffer, one would use the following acl :
9594
9595 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9596
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009597On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9598possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9599
9600 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009602All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9603criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9604method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9605to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9606criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9607the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009609If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009610the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9611For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009613 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9614 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9615 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9616 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009617
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009618
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009619The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9620types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9621combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9622brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9623default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009625 +-------------------------------------------------+
9626 | Input sample type |
9627 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009628 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009629 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9630 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9631 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009632 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009633 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009634 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009635 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009636 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009637 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009638 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009639 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009640 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009641 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009642 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009643 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009644 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009645 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009646 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009647 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009648 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009649 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009650 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009651 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009652 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009653 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9654 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9655 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009656
9657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096587.1.1. Matching booleans
9659------------------------
9660
9661In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9662Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9663When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9664that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9665
9666Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9667return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9668"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9669
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020096717.1.2. Matching integers
9672------------------------
9673
9674Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9675enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9676to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9677
9678Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9679matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9680lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009681
9682For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9683unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9684representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9685
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009686As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9687two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9688instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9689ranges and operators.
9690
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009691For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009692operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9693Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9694of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009696Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009697
9698 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9699 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9700 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9701 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9702 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9703
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009704For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009705
9706 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9707
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009708This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9709
9710 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9711
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097137.1.3. Matching strings
9714-----------------------
9715
9716String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9717different forms :
9718
9719 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9720 patterns ;
9721
9722 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9723 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9724
9725 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9726 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9727
9728 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9729 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9730
9731 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9732 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9733 matches.
9734
9735 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9736 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9737 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009738
9739String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9740exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9741characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9742string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9743to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009744before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009745
9746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097477.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9748---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009749
9750Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9751they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9752possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9753passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9754the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009755the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9756match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009757
9758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097597.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9760-------------------------------------
9761
9762It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9763not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9764a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9765to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9766digits may be used upper or lower case.
9767
9768Example :
9769 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9770 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9771
9772
97737.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9774---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009775
9776IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9777netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9778within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009779host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009780difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9781at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9782does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9783parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009784
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009785IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9786Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9787trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9788IPv6 patterns.
9789
9790HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9791following situations :
9792 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9793 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9794 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9795 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9796 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9797 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9798 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9799 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9800 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9801 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009803
98047.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9805----------------------------------
9806
9807Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9808combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9809
9810 - AND (implicit)
9811 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9812 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009814A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009816 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009818Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9819indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009821For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9822"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9823requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9824is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9825
9826 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9827 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9828 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9829 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9830
9831To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9832and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9833
9834 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9835 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9836 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9837 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9838
9839 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9840 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9841 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9842 use_backend www if host_www
9843
9844It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9845expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9846be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9847the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9848
9849 The following rule :
9850
9851 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9852 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9853
9854 Can also be written that way :
9855
9856 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9857
9858It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9859to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9860simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9861sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9862good use is the following :
9863
9864 With named ACLs :
9865
9866 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9867 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9868 monitor fail if site_dead
9869
9870 With anonymous ACLs :
9871
9872 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9873
9874See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9875
9876
98777.3. Fetching samples
9878---------------------
9879
9880Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9881against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9882sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9883ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9884of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9885available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9886
9887This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9888Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9889compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9890deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9891
9892The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9893matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9894method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9895indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9896
9897As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9898when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9899mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9900the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9901ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9902
9903Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9904multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9905when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9906incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9907are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9908is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9909all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9910
9911Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9912 - name
9913 - name(arg1)
9914 - name(arg1,arg2)
9915
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009916
99177.3.1. Converters
9918-----------------
9919
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009920Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9921of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9922is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9923was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9924has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9925unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9926
9927These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9928sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9929the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9930support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009932The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009933
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009934base64
9935 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9936 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9937 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9938
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009939hex
9940 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9941 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9942 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9943 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009944
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009945http_date([<offset>])
9946 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9947 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9948 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9949 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9950 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9951 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009952
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +02009953ipmask(<mask>)
9954 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9955 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9956 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9957 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9958
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009959language(<value>[,<default>])
9960 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9961 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9962 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9963 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9964 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9965 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9966 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9967 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9968 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9969 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9970 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9971 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009972
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009973 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009974
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009975 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9976 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009977
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009978 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9979 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9980 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9981 use_backend spanish if es
9982 use_backend french if fr
9983 use_backend english if en
9984 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009985
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +02009986lower
9987 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9988 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9989 type. The result is of type string.
9990
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009991map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9992map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9993map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9994 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9995 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9996 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9997 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9998 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9999 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10000 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10001 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010002
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010003 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10004 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10005 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010006
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010007 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10008 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010009
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010010 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10011 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10012 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10013 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010014 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10015 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010016 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10017 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10018 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10019 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10020 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10021 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10022 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10023 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10024 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10025 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10026 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10027 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10028 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10029 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010030
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010031 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10032 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10033 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10034 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10035 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010036
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010037 Example :
10038
10039 # this is a comment and is ignored
10040 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10041 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10042 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10043 | | | `---------- value
10044 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10045 | `---------------------------- key
10046 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10047
Willy Tarreau644d9ef2014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010048upper
10049 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10050 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10051 type. The result is of type string.
10052
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010053
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200100547.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010055--------------------------------------------
10056
10057A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10058not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10059"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10060The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10061
10062always_false : boolean
10063 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10064 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10065
10066always_true : boolean
10067 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10068 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10069
10070avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010071 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010072 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10073 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10074 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10075 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10076 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10077 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10078 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10079 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10080 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10081 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10082 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10083 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10084 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010086be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010087 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10088 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10089 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10090 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10091 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010093be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10094 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10095 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10096 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10097 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10098 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10099 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010100
10101 Example :
10102 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10103 backend dynamic
10104 mode http
10105 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10106 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010108connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10109 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010110 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010111 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10112 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010113
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010114 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010115 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010116 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10117
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010118 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10119 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010120
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010121 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010122 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010123 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010124 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10125 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010126 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010127 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010128
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010129 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10130 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010131 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010132 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010133
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010134date([<offset>]) : integer
10135 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10136 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10137 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10138 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010139 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10140
10141 Example :
10142
10143 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10144 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010145
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010146env(<name>) : string
10147 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10148 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10149 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10150 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10151 certain way.
10152
10153 Examples :
10154 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10155 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10156
10157 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10158 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010160fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10161 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010162 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10163 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010164 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10165 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10166 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10167 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10168 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010170fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10171 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10172 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10173 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10174 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10175 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10176 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10177 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10178 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010179
10180 Example :
10181 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10182 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10183 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10184 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10185 frontend mail
10186 bind :25
10187 mode tcp
10188 maxconn 100
10189 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10190 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10191 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10192 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010193
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010194nbproc : integer
10195 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10196 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10197 and debugging purposes.
10198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010199nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10200 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10201 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10202 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010203 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10204 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10205 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010206
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010207proc : integer
10208 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10209 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10210 debugging purposes.
10211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010212queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010213 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10214 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10215 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010216 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10217 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10218 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10219 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10220 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10221
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010222rand([<range>]) : integer
10223 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10224 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10225 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10226 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10227 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010229srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10230 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10231 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10232 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10233 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10234 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10235 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10236 methods.
10237
10238srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10239 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10240 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10241 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10242 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10243 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10244 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10245 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10246
10247srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10248 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10249 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010250 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010251 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10252 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10253 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10254 overloading servers).
10255
10256 Example :
10257 # Redirect to a separate back
10258 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10259 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10260 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10261
Willy Tarreaufad7f072014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010262stopping : boolean
10263 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10264 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10265 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010267table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10268 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10269 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10270
10271table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10272 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10273 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10274 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10275
10276
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200102777.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010278----------------------------------
10279
10280The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10281closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10282methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10283sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10284TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010285the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10286counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10287"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010288argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10289the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10290this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010291
10292be_id : integer
10293 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10294 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10295
10296dst : ip
10297 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10298 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10299 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10300 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10301 RFC 4291.
10302
10303dst_conn : integer
10304 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10305 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10306 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10307 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10308 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10309 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10310 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10311 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010313dst_port : integer
10314 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10315 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10316 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10317 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10318 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10319 an HTTP header.
10320
10321fe_id : integer
10322 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10323 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10324 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10325
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010326sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010327sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10328sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10329sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010330 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10331 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10332 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10333
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010334sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010335sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10336sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10337sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010338 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10339 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10340 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10341
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010342sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010343sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10344sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10345sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010346 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10347 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010348 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10349 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10350 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010351
10352 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10353 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010354 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10355 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10356 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010357 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10358 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10359
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010360sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010361sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10362sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10363sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010364 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10365 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10366
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010367sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010368sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10369sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10370sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010371 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10372 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10373 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10374
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010375sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010376sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10377sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10378sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010379 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10380 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10381 See also src_conn_rate.
10382
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010383sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010384sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10385sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10386sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010387 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010388 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010389
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010390sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010391sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10392sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10393sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010394 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10395 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10396 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010397 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10398 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10399 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010400
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010401sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010402sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10403sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10404sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010405 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10406 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10407 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10408
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010409sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010410sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10411sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10412sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010413 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10414 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10415 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10416 src_http_err_rate.
10417
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010418sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010419sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10420sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10421sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010422 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10423 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10424 src_http_req_cnt.
10425
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010426sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010427sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10428sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10429sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010430 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10431 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10432 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10433 src_http_req_rate.
10434
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010435sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010436sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10437sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10438sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010439 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010440 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10441 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10442 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10443 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010444
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010445 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10446 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010447 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10448
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010449sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010450sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10451sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10452sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010453 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10454 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10455 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010456
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010457sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010458sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10459sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10460sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010461 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10462 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10463 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010464
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010465sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010466sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10467sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10468sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010469 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10470 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10471 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10472 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010473 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010474 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10475
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010476sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010477sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10478sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10479sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010480 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10481 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10482 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10483 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10484 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010485 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010486
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010487sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010488sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10489sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10490sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010491 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10492 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10493 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10494
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010495sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010496sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10497sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10498sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010499 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10500 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010501 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010502 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10503 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010504 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10505 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10506 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010508so_id : integer
10509 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10510 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10511 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010513src : ip
10514 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10515 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10516 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10517 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10518 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10519 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10520 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010521
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010522 Example:
10523 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10524 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010526src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10527 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10528 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10529 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010530 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010532src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10533 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10534 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010535 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010536 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010538src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10539 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10540 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10541 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10542 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10543 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10544 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010545
10546 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10547 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10548 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10549 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010550 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010551 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10552 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010554src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010555 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010556 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010557 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010558 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010560src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010561 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010562 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10563 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010564 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010566src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10567 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10568 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10569 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010570 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010572src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010573 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010574 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010575 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010576 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010578src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010579 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010580 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010581 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10582 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010583 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10584 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10585 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010587src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10588 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10589 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010590 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010591 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010592 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010594src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10595 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10596 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10597 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10598 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010599 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010601src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10602 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10603 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10604 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010605 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010607src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10608 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10609 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10610 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010611 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010612 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010614src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10615 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10616 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10617 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010618 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010619 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10620 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010621
10622 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010623 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010624 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010626src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010627 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10628 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10629 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10630 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10631 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010633src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau911780c2014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010634 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
10635 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10636 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
10637 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10638 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010640src_port : integer
10641 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10642 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10643 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10644 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010646src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10647 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010648 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10649 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10650 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010651 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010653src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10654 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10655 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10656 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10657 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010658 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010660src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10661 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10662 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10663 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10664 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10665 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10666 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10667 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10668 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010669
10670 Example :
10671 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10672 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10673 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10674 listen ssh
10675 bind :22
10676 mode tcp
10677 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010678 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010679 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010680 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010682srv_id : integer
10683 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10684 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10685 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010686
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010687
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010689----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010691The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10692closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10693when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10694usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010695future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010696
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010697ssl_bc : boolean
10698 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10699 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10700 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10701
10702ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10703 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10704 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10705
10706ssl_bc_cipher : string
10707 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10708 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10709
10710ssl_bc_protocol : string
10711 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10712 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10713
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010714ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010715 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010716 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10717 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010718
10719ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10720 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10721 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10722 if session was reused or not.
10723
10724ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10725 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10726 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010728ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10729 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10730 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10731 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10732 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10733 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010735ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10736 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10737 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10738 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10739 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010740
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010741ssl_c_der : binary
10742 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
10743 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10744 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010746ssl_c_err : integer
10747 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10748 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10749 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10750 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10751 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010753ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10754 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10755 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10756 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10757 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10758 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10759 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10760 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10761 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010763ssl_c_key_alg : string
10764 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10765 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10766 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010768ssl_c_notafter : string
10769 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10770 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10771 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010773ssl_c_notbefore : string
10774 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10775 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10776 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010778ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10779 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10780 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10781 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10782 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10783 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10784 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10785 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10786 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010788ssl_c_serial : binary
10789 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10790 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10791 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010793ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10794 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10795 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10796 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau9fe4cb62014-07-02 19:01:22 +020010797 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
10798 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
10799
10800 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010802ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10803 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10804 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10805 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010807ssl_c_used : boolean
10808 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10809 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010811ssl_c_verify : integer
10812 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10813 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10814 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10815 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010817ssl_c_version : integer
10818 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10819 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010820
Emeric Brunb3cc4252014-10-29 19:03:26 +010010821ssl_f_der : binary
10822 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
10823 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10824 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
10825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010826ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10827 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10828 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10829 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10830 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010831 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010832 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10833 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10834 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010836ssl_f_key_alg : string
10837 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10838 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10839 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010841ssl_f_notafter : string
10842 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10843 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10844 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010846ssl_f_notbefore : string
10847 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10848 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10849 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010851ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10852 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10853 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10854 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10855 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10856 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10857 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10858 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10859 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010861ssl_f_serial : binary
10862 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10863 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10864 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010865
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010866ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10867 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10868 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10869 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010871ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10872 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10873 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10874 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010876ssl_f_version : integer
10877 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10878 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10879
10880ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010881 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10882 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10883 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010885 Example :
10886 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10887 listen http-https
10888 bind :80
10889 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10890 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10891
10892ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10893 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10894 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10895
10896ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010897 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010898 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10899 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10900 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10901 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10902 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10903 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10904 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10905 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010907ssl_fc_cipher : string
10908 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10909 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010911ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010912 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10913 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010914 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10915 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10916 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10917 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010919ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10920 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010921 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10922 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10923 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10924 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010926ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010927 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010928 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10929 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10930 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10931 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10932 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10933 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10934 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010936ssl_fc_protocol : string
10937 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10938 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010939
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010940ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010941 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010942 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10943 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010945ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10946 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10947 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10948 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10949 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010951ssl_fc_sni : string
10952 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10953 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10954 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10955 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10956 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10957
10958 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10959 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10960 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010961 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10962 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010964 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010965 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10966 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010968ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10969 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10970 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010971
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010972
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109737.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010974------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010976Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10977sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10978only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10979For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10980be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10981can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10982sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10983for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10984content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010986payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10987 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10988 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10989 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010991payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10992 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10993 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10994 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010996req.len : integer
10997req_len : integer (deprecated)
10998 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10999 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11000 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11001 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11002 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11003 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11004 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11005 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011007req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11008 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011009 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11010 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11011 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11012 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011014 ACL alternatives :
11015 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011017req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11018 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11019 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11020 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11021 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011023 ACL alternatives :
11024 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011026 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011028req.proto_http : boolean
11029req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11030 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11031 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11032 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11033 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11034 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11035 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11036 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011038 Example:
11039 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11040 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11041 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011042 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011044req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11045rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11046 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11047 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11048 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11049 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11050 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11051 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11052 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011054 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11055 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11056 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11057 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11058 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11059 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011061 ACL derivatives :
11062 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011064 Example :
11065 listen tse-farm
11066 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11067 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11068 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11069 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11070 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11071 persist rdp-cookie
11072 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11073 # This is only useful makes sense if
11074 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11075 stick-table type string size 204800
11076 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11077 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11078 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011080 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11081 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011083req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11084rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11085 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11086 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11087 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11088 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011090 ACL derivatives :
11091 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011093req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11094req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11095 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11096 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11097 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11098 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11099 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11100 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11101 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011103req.ssl_sni : string
11104req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11105 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11106 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11107 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11108 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11109 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11110 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11111 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11112 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11113 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11114 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11115 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11116 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011118 ACL derivatives :
11119 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011121 Examples :
11122 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11123 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11124 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11125 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11126 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011128res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11129rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11130 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11131 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11132 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11133 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11134 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11135 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11136 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011138req.ssl_ver : integer
11139req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11140 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11141 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11142 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11143 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11144 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11145 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11146 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11147 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11148 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011150 ACL derivatives :
11151 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011152
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011153res.len : integer
11154 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11155 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11156 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11157 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11158 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11159 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11160 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11161 content inspection.
11162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011163res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11164 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011165 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11166 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11167 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11168 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011170res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11171 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11172 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11173 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11174 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011176 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011178wait_end : boolean
11179 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11180 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11181 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11182 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11183 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11184 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11185 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11186 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011188 Examples :
11189 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11190 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11191 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011193 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11194 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11195 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11196 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11197 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11198 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11199 tcp-request content reject
11200
11201
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200112027.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011203--------------------------------------
11204
11205It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11206This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11207data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11208its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11209HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11210content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11211to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11212more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11213response are indexed.
11214
11215base : string
11216 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11217 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11218 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11219 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11220 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11221 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11222 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11223 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11224
11225 ACL derivatives :
11226 base : exact string match
11227 base_beg : prefix match
11228 base_dir : subdir match
11229 base_dom : domain match
11230 base_end : suffix match
11231 base_len : length match
11232 base_reg : regex match
11233 base_sub : substring match
11234
11235base32 : integer
11236 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11237 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11238 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11239 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11240
11241base32+src : binary
11242 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11243 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11244 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11245 per-URL counters.
11246
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011247capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11248 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11249 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11250 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11251
11252capture.req.method : string
11253 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11254 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11255 because it's allocated.
11256
11257capture.req.uri : string
11258 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11259 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11260 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11261 allocated.
11262
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011263capture.req.ver : string
11264 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11265 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11266 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11267
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011268capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11269 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11270 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11271 The first entry is an index of 0.
11272 See also: "capture response header"
11273
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011274capture.res.ver : string
11275 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11276 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11277 persistent flag.
11278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011279req.cook([<name>]) : string
11280cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11281 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11282 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11283 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11284 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11285 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11286 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11287 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11288 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11289
11290 ACL derivatives :
11291 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11292 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11293 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11294 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11295 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11296 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11297 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11298 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011300req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11301cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11302 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11303 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011305req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11306cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11307 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11308 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11309 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11310 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011312cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11313 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11314 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11315 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11316 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11317 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11318 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11319 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11320 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11321 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11322 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011324hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11325 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11326 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11327 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11328 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011329 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011331req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11332 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11333 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11334 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11335 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11336 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11337 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11338 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11339 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011341req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11342 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11343 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11344 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11345 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011347req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11348 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11349 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11350 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11351 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11352 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11353 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11354 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11355 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11356 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11357 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11358 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011360 ACL derivatives :
11361 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11362 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11363 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11364 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11365 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11366 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11367 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11368 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11369
11370req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11371hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11372 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11373 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11374 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11375 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11376 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11377 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11378 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11379 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11380 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11381
11382req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11383hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11384 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11385 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11386 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11387 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11388 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11389 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11390 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11391 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11392
11393req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11394hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11395 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11396 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11397 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11398 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11399 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11400 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11401 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11402
11403http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11404 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11405 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11406 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11407 basic auth is supported.
11408
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011409http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11410 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11411 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11412 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11413 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011414 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11415 basic auth is supported.
11416
11417 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011418 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11419 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11420 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11421 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011422
11423http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011424 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11425 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011426 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11427 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011429method : integer + string
11430 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11431 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11432 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11433 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11434 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11435 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11436 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011438 ACL derivatives :
11439 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011441 Example :
11442 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11443 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11444 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011446path : string
11447 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11448 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11449 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11450 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11451 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11452 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11453 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011455 ACL derivatives :
11456 path : exact string match
11457 path_beg : prefix match
11458 path_dir : subdir match
11459 path_dom : domain match
11460 path_end : suffix match
11461 path_len : length match
11462 path_reg : regex match
11463 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011465req.ver : string
11466req_ver : string (deprecated)
11467 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11468 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11469 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011471 ACL derivatives :
11472 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011474res.comp : boolean
11475 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11476 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11477 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011479res.comp_algo : string
11480 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11481 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11482 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011484res.cook([<name>]) : string
11485scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11486 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11487 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11488 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011490 ACL derivatives :
11491 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011493res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11494scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11495 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11496 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11497 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011499res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11500scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11501 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11502 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11503 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011505res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11506 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11507 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11508 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11509 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11510 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11511 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11512 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11513 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11514 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011516res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11517 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11518 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11519 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11520 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11521 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011523res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11524shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11525 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11526 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11527 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11528 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11529 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11530 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11531 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11532 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011534 ACL derivatives :
11535 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11536 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11537 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11538 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11539 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11540 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11541 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11542 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11543
11544res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11545shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11546 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11547 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11548 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11549 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11550 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011552res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11553shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11554 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11555 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11556 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11557 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11558 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11559 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011561res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11562shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11563 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11564 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11565 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11566 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11567 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11568 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011570res.ver : string
11571resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11572 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11573 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011575 ACL derivatives :
11576 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011578set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11579 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11580 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11581 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11582 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011584 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11585 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011587 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011589status : integer
11590 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11591 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11592 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011594url : string
11595 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11596 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11597 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11598 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11599 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11600 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11601 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011603 ACL derivatives :
11604 url : exact string match
11605 url_beg : prefix match
11606 url_dir : subdir match
11607 url_dom : domain match
11608 url_end : suffix match
11609 url_len : length match
11610 url_reg : regex match
11611 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011613url_ip : ip
11614 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11615 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11616 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11617 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11618 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11619 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11620 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011622url_port : integer
11623 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11624 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11625 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11626 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011628urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11629url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11630 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11631 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11632 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11633 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11634 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11635 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11636 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11637 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11638 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011640 ACL derivatives :
11641 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11642 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11643 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11644 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11645 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11646 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11647 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11648 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011649
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011651 Example :
11652 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11653 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11654 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11655 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011657urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11658 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11659 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11660 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011661
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116637.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011664---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011666Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11667every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011668order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011670ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11671---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011672FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011673HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011674HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11675HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011676HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11677HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11678HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11679HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11680LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011681METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11682METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11683METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11684METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11685METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11686METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011687RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011688REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011689TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011690WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11691---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011692
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116948. Logging
11695----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011696
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011697One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11698provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11699very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11700provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11701state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011702to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011703headers.
11704
11705In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11706about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11707send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11708
11709 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11710 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11711 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11712 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11713 at the termination.
11714
11715The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11716allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11717as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11718while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11719real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11720delay.
11721
11722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117238.1. Log levels
11724---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011725
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011726TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011727source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011728HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11729in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11730track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11731syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11732about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011733
11734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117358.2. Log formats
11736----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011737
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011738HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011739and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11740slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11741options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011742
11743 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11744 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11745 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11746 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11747 extents.
11748
11749 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11750 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11751 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11752 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11753 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11754
11755 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11756 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11757 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11758 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11759 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11760
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011761 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11762 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11763 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11764 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11765
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011766 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11767
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011768Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11769specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11770field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11771servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11772always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11773identifier.
11774
11775Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11776 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11777 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11778 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11779 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11780
11781
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117828.2.1. Default log format
11783-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011784
11785This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11786as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11787format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11788
11789 Example :
11790 listen www
11791 mode http
11792 log global
11793 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11794
11795 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11796 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11797 (www/HTTP)
11798
11799 Field Format Extract from the example above
11800 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11801 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11802 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11803 4 'to' to
11804 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11805 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11806
11807Detailed fields description :
11808 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11809 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11810 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11811 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11812 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11813 and processed the connection.
11814 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11815
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011816In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11817"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11818connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11819
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011820It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11821will eventually disappear.
11822
11823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118248.2.2. TCP log format
11825---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011826
11827The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11828is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11829information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11830counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11831emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11832environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11833the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11834sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011835specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11836not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11837fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11838marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011839
11840 Example :
11841 frontend fnt
11842 mode tcp
11843 option tcplog
11844 log global
11845 default_backend bck
11846
11847 backend bck
11848 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11849
11850 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11851 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11852 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11853
11854 Field Format Extract from the example above
11855 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11856 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11857 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11858 4 frontend_name fnt
11859 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11860 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11861 7 bytes_read* 212
11862 8 termination_state --
11863 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11864 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11865
11866Detailed fields description :
11867 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011868 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11869 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11870 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11871 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11872 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011873
11874 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011875 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11876 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11877 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011878
11879 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11880 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11881 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11882 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11883
11884 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11885 and processed the connection.
11886
11887 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11888 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11889 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11890 applications.
11891
11892 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11893 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11894 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11895 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11896 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11897
11898 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11899 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11900 See "Timers" below for more details.
11901
11902 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11903 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11904 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11905 "Timers" below for more details.
11906
11907 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011908 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011909 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11910 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11911 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11912 details.
11913
11914 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11915 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11916 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11917 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11918 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11919
11920 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11921 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11922 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11923 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11924 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11925 for more details.
11926
11927 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011928 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011929 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11930 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11931 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011932 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011933
11934 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11935 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11936 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11937 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11938 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11939 caused by a denial of service attack.
11940
11941 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11942 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11943 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11944 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11945 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11946 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11947 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11948 denial of service attack.
11949
11950 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11951 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11952 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11953 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11954 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11955 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11956 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11957 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11958 be processed than on other servers.
11959
11960 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11961 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11962 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11963 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11964 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11965 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11966 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11967 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11968 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11969 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11970 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11971 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11972 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11973
11974 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11975 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11976 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11977 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11978 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11979 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11980 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11981 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11982
11983 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11984 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11985 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11986 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11987 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11988 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11989 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11990 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11991 occurs.
11992
11993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119948.2.3. HTTP log format
11995----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011996
11997The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11998is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11999the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12000are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12001emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12002generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12003"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12004which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012005frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12006is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012007
12008Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12009slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12010with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12011
12012 Example :
12013 frontend http-in
12014 mode http
12015 option httplog
12016 log global
12017 default_backend bck
12018
12019 backend static
12020 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12021
12022 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12023 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12024 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012025 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012026
12027 Field Format Extract from the example above
12028 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12029 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12030 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12031 4 frontend_name http-in
12032 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12033 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12034 7 status_code 200
12035 8 bytes_read* 2750
12036 9 captured_request_cookie -
12037 10 captured_response_cookie -
12038 11 termination_state ----
12039 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12040 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12041 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12042 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12043 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012044
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012045
12046Detailed fields description :
12047 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012048 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12049 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12050 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12051 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12052 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012053
12054 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012055 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12056 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12057 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012058
12059 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12060 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12061 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12062 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12063 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12064
12065 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12066 and processed the connection.
12067
12068 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12069 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12070 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12071
12072 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12073 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12074 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12075 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12076 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12077 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12078
12079 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12080 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12081 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12082 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12083 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12084 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12085
12086 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12087 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12088 See "Timers" below for more details.
12089
12090 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12091 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12092 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12093 below for more details.
12094
12095 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12096 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12097 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12098 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12099 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12100 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12101 for more details.
12102
12103 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012104 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012105 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12106 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12107 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12108 details.
12109
12110 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12111 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12112 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12113
12114 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12115 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12116 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12117 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12118 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12119 overflowing.
12120
12121 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12122 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12123 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12124 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12125 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12126 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12127 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12128 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12129
12130 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12131 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12132 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12133 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12134 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12135 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12136 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12137 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12138
12139 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12140 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12141 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12142 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12143 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12144 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12145 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12146
12147 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012148 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012149 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12150 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12151 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012152 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012153 system.
12154
12155 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12156 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12157 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12158 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12159 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12160 caused by a denial of service attack.
12161
12162 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12163 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12164 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12165 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12166 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12167 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12168 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12169 denial of service attack.
12170
12171 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12172 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12173 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12174 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12175 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12176 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12177 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12178 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12179 processed than on other servers.
12180
12181 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12182 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12183 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12184 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12185 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12186 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12187 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12188 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12189 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12190 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12191 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12192 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12193 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12194
12195 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12196 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12197 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12198 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12199 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12200 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12201 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12202 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12203
12204 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12205 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12206 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12207 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12208 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12209 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12210 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12211 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12212 occurs.
12213
12214 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12215 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12216 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12217 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12218 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12219 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12220 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12221 cookies" below for more details.
12222
12223 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12224 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12225 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12226 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12227 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12228 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12229 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12230 and cookies" below for more details.
12231
12232 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12233 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12234 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12235 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12236 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12237 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12238 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12239 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12240
12241
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200122428.2.4. Custom log format
12243------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012244
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012245The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012246mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012247
12248HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12249Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12250separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12251prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12252
12253Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12254variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12255string formats ("Q").
12256
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012257If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012258as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012259less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12260the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12261
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012262Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012263In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012264in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012265
12266Flags are :
12267 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012268 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012269
12270 Example:
12271
12272 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12273 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12274
12275At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12276
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012277 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12278 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012279
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012280the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012281
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012282 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012283 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012284 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012285
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012286and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12287
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012288 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012289 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12290
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012291Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12292
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012293 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012294 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012295 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12296 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12297 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012298 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12299 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12300 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012301 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012302 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012303 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012304 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012305 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012306 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012307 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12308 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012309 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012310 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12311 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012312 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012313 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12314 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012315 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12316 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12317 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012318 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012319 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12320 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012321 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012322 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12323 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12324 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012325 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012326 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12327 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12328 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12329 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012330 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012331 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012332 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012333 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012334 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012335 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012336 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12337 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12338 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012339 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012340 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12341 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012342 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012343 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012344 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012345 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012346
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012347 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012348
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012349
123508.2.5. Error log format
12351-----------------------
12352
12353When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12354protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12355By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12356"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12357will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12358logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12359
12360The format looks like this :
12361
12362 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12363 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12364 Connection error during SSL handshake
12365
12366 Field Format Extract from the example above
12367 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12368 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12369 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12370 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12371 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12372
12373These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12374failures.
12375
12376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123778.3. Advanced logging options
12378-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012379
12380Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12381just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12382options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12383for more information about their usage.
12384
12385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123868.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12387------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012388
12389It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12390haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12391commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12392monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12393ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12394
12395 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12396 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12397 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12398 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12399
12400 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12401 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12402 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012403 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012404 such as other load-balancers.
12405
12406 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12407 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12408 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12409
12410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124118.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12412----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012413
12414The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12415what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12416or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12417"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12418just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12419log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12420after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12421is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12422with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12423with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12424
12425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124268.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12427------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012428
12429Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12430for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12431"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12432retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12433raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12434a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12435file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12436you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12437"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12438
12439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124408.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12441--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012442
12443Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12444multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12445them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12446"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12447logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12448error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12449and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12450too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12451useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12452alternative.
12453
12454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124558.4. Timing events
12456------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012457
12458Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12459reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12460the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12461frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12462mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12463
12464 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12465 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12466 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12467 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12468 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12469
12470 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12471 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12472 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12473 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12474 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12475
12476 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12477 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12478 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12479 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12480 connection never established.
12481
12482 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12483 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12484 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12485 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12486 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12487 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12488 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12489 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12490 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12491 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12492 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12493
12494 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12495 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12496 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12497 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012498 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012499
12500 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12501
12502 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12503 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12504 negative.
12505
12506These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12507protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12508that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012509due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012510close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12511session has been aborted on timeout.
12512
12513Most common cases :
12514
12515 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12516 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12517 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12518 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12519 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12520 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12521 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12522 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12523 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012524 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12525 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12526 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012527
12528 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12529 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12530 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12531 of ms on remote networks.
12532
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012533 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12534 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12535 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012536
12537 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12538 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12539 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12540 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12541 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12542 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12543 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12544 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12545 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12546 to the server until another one is released.
12547
12548Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12549
12550 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12551 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12552 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12553
12554 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12555 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12556 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12557
12558 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12559 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12560 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12561 flags.
12562
12563 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12564 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12565 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12566 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12567 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12568 the client connection was maintained open.
12569
12570 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012571 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012572 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12573 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12574
12575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125768.5. Session state at disconnection
12577-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012578
12579TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12580"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
125812-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12582each of which has a special meaning :
12583
12584 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12585 session to terminate :
12586
12587 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12588
12589 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12590 server explicitly refused it.
12591
12592 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12593 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12594 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12595 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012596 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12597
12598 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12599 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012600
12601 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12602 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12603 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12604 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12605 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12606
12607 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12608 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12609 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12610 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12611 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12612
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012613 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12614 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12615
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012616 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12617 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12618 backup connections when going up.
12619
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012620 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12621
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012622 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12623 send or receive data.
12624
12625 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12626 send or receive data.
12627
12628 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12629 with nothing left in the buffers.
12630
12631 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12632
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012633 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012634 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12635
12636 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12637 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12638 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12639 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12640 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12641
12642 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12643 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12644
12645 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12646 server (HTTP only).
12647
12648 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12649
12650 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12651 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12652 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12653
12654 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12655 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12656 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12657
12658 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12659
12660 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12661 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12662
12663 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12664 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12665 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12666
12667 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12668 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012669 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12670 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012671
12672 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12673 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12674 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12675 another server.
12676
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012677 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012678 server.
12679
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012680 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12681 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12682 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12683 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12684
12685 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12686 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12687 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12688 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12689
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012690 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12691 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12692 "use-server" rule).
12693
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012694 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12695
12696 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12697 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12698
12699 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12700
12701 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12702 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12703 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12704
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012705 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12706 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012707 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012708 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12709 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12710
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012711 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12712
12713 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12714 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12715
12716 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12717
12718 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12719
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012720The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12721was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012722helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12723starvation, attacks, etc...
12724
12725The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12726alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12727easier finding and understanding.
12728
12729 Flags Reason
12730
12731 -- Normal termination.
12732
12733 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12734 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12735 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12736 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12737
12738 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12739 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12740 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12741 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12742 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12743 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012744
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012745 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12746 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012747 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012748
12749 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12750 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12751 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12752
12753 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12754 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12755 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12756 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12757 the server takes too long to respond.
12758
12759 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12760 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12761 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12762 long a time to respond.
12763
12764 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12765 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12766 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12767 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12768 and the client.
12769
12770 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12771 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12772 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12773 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12774 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012775 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12776 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12777 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12778 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12779 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12780 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12781 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12782 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12783 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12784 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12785 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12786 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12787 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12788 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012789
12790 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12791 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012792 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12793 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12794 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12795 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012796
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012797 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12798 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12799
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012800 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012801 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12802 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12803 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12804 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12805 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12806
12807 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12808 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12809 503 or 504 here.
12810
12811 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12812 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12813 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12814 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12815 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12816
12817 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12818 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012819 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012820 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12821 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12822
12823 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12824 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12825 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12826 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12827 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12828 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12829 between haproxy and the server.
12830
12831 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12832 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12833 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12834 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12835 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12836 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12837 solution is to fix the application.
12838
12839 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12840 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12841 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12842 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12843 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12844 external attacks.
12845
12846 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12847 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012848 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012849 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12850 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12851
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012852 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12853 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12854 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012855 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12856 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012857
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012858 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12859 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12860 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12861 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012862 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12863 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12864 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12865 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12866 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012867
12868 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12869 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12870 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12871 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12872
12873 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12874 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12875 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12876 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12877
12878 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12879 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12880 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12881 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12882
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012883The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12884persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12885important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12886re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12887
12888 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12889
12890 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12891 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12892 set on a GET request.
12893
12894 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12895 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012896 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012897 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12898
12899 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12900 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12901 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12902
12903 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12904 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12905 already got a cookie.
12906
12907 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12908 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12909 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12910 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12911 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12912
12913 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12914 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12915 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12916
12917 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12918 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12919 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12920
12921 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12922 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12923
12924 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12925 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12926 then advertised in the response.
12927
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129298.6. Non-printable characters
12930-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012931
12932In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12933consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12934converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12935prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12936being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12937escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12938is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12939'}' when logging headers.
12940
12941Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12942issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12943containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12944
12945Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12946the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12947performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12948
12949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129508.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12951---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012952
12953Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12954achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012955section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012956cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12957the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12958the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012959locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012960not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12961user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12962a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12963wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12964
12965 Examples :
12966 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12967 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12968
12969 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12970 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12971
12972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129738.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12974---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012975
12976Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12977proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12978the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12979server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12980
12981Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12982response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012983section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012984
12985It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012986time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12987appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012988are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12989and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12990follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12991request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12992in the logs.
12993
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012994As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
12995frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
12996an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
12997
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012998 Example :
12999 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13000 listen proxy-out
13001 mode http
13002 option httplog
13003 option logasap
13004 log global
13005 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13006
13007 # log the name of the virtual server
13008 capture request header Host len 20
13009
13010 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13011 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13012
13013 # log the beginning of the referrer
13014 capture request header Referer len 20
13015
13016 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13017 capture response header Server len 20
13018
13019 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13020 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13021
13022 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13023 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13024
13025 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13026 capture response header Via len 20
13027
13028 # log the URL location during a redirection
13029 capture response header Location len 20
13030
13031 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13032 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13033 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13034 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13035 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13036
13037 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13038 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13039 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13040 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013041 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013042
13043 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13044 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13045 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13046 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13047 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013048 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013049
13050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130518.9. Examples of logs
13052---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013053
13054These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13055them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13056reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13057
13058 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13059 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13060 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13061
13062 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13063 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13064
13065 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13066 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13067 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13068
13069 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13070 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13071
13072 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13073 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13074 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13075
13076 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013077 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013078 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13079 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13080
13081 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13082 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13083 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13084
13085 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13086 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013087 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013088 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13089 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13090 to return the 502 and not the server.
13091
13092 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013093 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013094
13095 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13096 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13097 Nothing was sent to any server.
13098
13099 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13100 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13101
13102 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13103 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13104 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13105 send a 408 return code to the client.
13106
13107 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13108 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13109
13110 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13111 5 seconds ("c----").
13112
13113 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13114 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013115 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013116
13117 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013118 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013119 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13120 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13121 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13122 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13123 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013124
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131269. Statistics and monitoring
13127----------------------------
13128
13129It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13130mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13131CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13132Unix socket.
13133
13134
131359.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013136---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013137
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013138The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013139page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13140begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13141represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13142use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13143('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13144(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13145text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13146do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13147use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013148
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013149In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13150that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13151S (Servers).
13152
13153 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13154 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13155 any name for server/listener)
13156 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13157 number queued without a server assigned.
13158 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13159 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13160 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13161 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13162 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13163 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13164 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13165 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13166 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13167 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13168 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13169 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13170 "option checkcache".
13171 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13172 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13173 - read error from the client
13174 - client timeout
13175 - client closed connection
13176 - various bad requests from the client.
13177 - request was tarpitted.
13178 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13179 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13180 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13181 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13182 active servers).
13183 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13184 Some other errors are:
13185 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13186 - failure applying filters to the response.
13187 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13188 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13189 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13190 switched away from.
13191 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13192 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13193 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13194 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13195 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13196 the server is up.)
13197 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13198 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13199 counters for each server.
13200 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13201 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13202 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13203 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13204 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13205 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13206 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13207 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13208 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13209 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13210 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13211 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13212 of times that server was selected.
13213 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13214 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13215 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13216 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13217 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13218 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013219 UNK -> unknown
13220 INI -> initializing
13221 SOCKERR -> socket error
13222 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harveycac41222015-04-16 11:13:21 -080013223 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013224 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13225 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13226 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13227 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13228 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13229 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13230 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13231 disable-on-404
13232 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13233 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13234 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westby75c98ad2014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013235 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13236 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13237 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13238 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13239 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13240 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13241 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13242 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13243 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13244 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13245 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13246 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13247 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13248 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13249 (inc. in eresp)
13250 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13251 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13252 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13253 (CPU/BW limit)
13254 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13255 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13256 server/backend
13257 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13258 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13259 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13260 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13261 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13262 (0 for TCP)
13263 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13264 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013265
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132679.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013268-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013269
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013270The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13271necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13272A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13273issuing commands by hand :
13274
13275 global
13276 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13277 stats timeout 2m
13278
13279It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13280the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13281never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13282situations :
13283
13284 global
13285 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13286 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13287 stats timeout 2m
13288
13289To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13290swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13291to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13292syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13293
13294 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13295 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13296
13297The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13298script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13299for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13300
13301The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13302that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13303editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13304(eg: watch a counter).
13305
13306The socket supports two operation modes :
13307 - interactive
13308 - non-interactive
13309
13310The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13311this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13312sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13313mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13314commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13315example :
13316
13317 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13318
13319The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13320entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13321for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13322sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13323"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13324after processing the last command of the same line.
13325
13326For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13327"prompt" command :
13328
13329 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13330 prompt
13331 > show info
13332 ...
13333 >
13334
13335Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13336delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13337that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13338parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013339
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013340It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13341on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13342own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013343
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013344The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13345If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13346all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13347it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13348
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013349add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013350 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13351 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13352 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13353 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013354
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013355add map <map> <key> <value>
13356 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13357 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013358 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13359 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13360 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013361
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013362clear counters
13363 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13364 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13365 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13366 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13367 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13368
13369clear counters all
13370 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13371 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13372 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13373
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013374clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013375 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13376 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13377 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013378
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013379clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013380 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13381 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13382 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013383
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013384clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13385 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13386
13387 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13388 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13389 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13390 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13391 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13392 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13393
13394 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13395
13396 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13397 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13398 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13399 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13400 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13401 the ACLs :
13402
13403 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13404 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13405 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13406 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13407 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13408 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13409
13410 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013411 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13412 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013413
13414 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013415 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013416 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013417 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13418 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13419 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13420 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013421
13422 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13423
13424 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013425 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013426 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13427 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013428 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13429 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13430 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013431
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013432del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13433 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013434 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13435 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13436 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13437 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013438
13439del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013440 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013441 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13442 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13443 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13444 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013445
13446disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013447 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13448
13449 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13450 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13451 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13452 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13453 re-enabled using enable agent.
13454
13455 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13456 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13457 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13458 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13459 otherwise unchanged.
13460
13461 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13462 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13463 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13464
13465 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13466 level "admin".
13467
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013468disable frontend <frontend>
13469 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13470 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13471 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13472 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13473 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13474 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13475 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13476 on the stats page.
13477
13478 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13479 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13480
13481 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13482 level "admin".
13483
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013484disable health <backend>/<server>
13485 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13486 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13487 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13488 agent check forces it down.
13489
13490 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13491 level "admin".
13492
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013493disable server <backend>/<server>
13494 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13495 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13496 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13497 during the maintenance.
13498
13499 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13500 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13501
13502 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013503 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013504
13505 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13506 level "admin".
13507
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013508enable agent <backend>/<server>
13509 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13510
13511 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13512 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13513
13514 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13515 level "admin".
13516
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013517enable frontend <frontend>
13518 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13519 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13520 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13521 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13522 which was disabled.
13523
13524 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13525 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13526
13527 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13528 level "admin".
13529
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013530enable health <backend>/<server>
13531 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13532 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13533
13534 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13535 level "admin".
13536
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013537enable server <backend>/<server>
13538 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13539 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13540
13541 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013542 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013543
13544 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13545 level "admin".
13546
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013547get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013548get acl <acl> <value>
13549 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13550 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13551 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13552 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13553 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013554
13555 The first two words are:
13556
13557 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13558 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13559 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13560
13561 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13562
13563 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13564
13565 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13566
13567 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13568 interpretation of the case.
13569
13570 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13571 useful with regular expressions.
13572
13573 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13574 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13575
13576 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13577 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13578 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13579
13580 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13581
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013582get weight <backend>/<server>
13583 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13584 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13585 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13586 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13587 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013588 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013589
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013590help
13591 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13592 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013593
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013594prompt
13595 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13596 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13597 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13598 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13599 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13600 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13601 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13602 command.
13603
13604quit
13605 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013606
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013607set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013608 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13609 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13610 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013611
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013612set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013613 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13614 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13615 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13616 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13617 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013618 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13619 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13620
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013621set maxconn global <maxconn>
13622 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13623 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13624 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13625 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13626 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13627 setting.
13628
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013629set rate-limit connections global <value>
13630 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13631 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13632 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13633 is passed in number of connections per second.
13634
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013635set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13636 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13637 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013638 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13639 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013640
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013641set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13642 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13643 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13644 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13645 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13646
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013647set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13648 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13649 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13650 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13651 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13652 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13653
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013654set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13655 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13656 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13657 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13658
13659set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13660 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13661 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13662 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13663
13664set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13665 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13666 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13667 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13668 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13669 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13670 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13671 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13672 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13673
13674set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13675 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13676 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13677
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013678set ssl ocsp-response <response>
13679 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
13680 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
13681 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
13682 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
13683
13684 Example:
13685 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
13686 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
13687 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
13688 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
13689
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013690set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013691 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13692 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13693 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13694 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013695 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13696 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013697
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013698set timeout cli <delay>
13699 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13700 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13701 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13702
13703set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13704 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13705 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013706 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13707 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13708 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13709 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13710 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13711 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13712 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13713 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13714 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13715 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13716 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13717 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13718 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013719
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013720show errors [<iid>]
13721 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13722 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013723 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13724 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13725 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013726
13727 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13728 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13729 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13730 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13731 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13732 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13733 are reported too.
13734
13735 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13736 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13737 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13738 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13739 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13740 code.
13741
13742 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13743 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13744 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13745 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13746 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13747 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13748 line.
13749
13750 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013751 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13752 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013753 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13754 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13755
13756 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13757 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13758 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13759 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13760 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13761 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13762 00204+ minal\r\n
13763 00211 \r\n
13764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013765 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013766 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13767 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13768 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13769 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13770 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13771 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013772
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013773show info
13774 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13775
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013776show map [<map>]
13777 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013778 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13779 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13780 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13781 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13782 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13783 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013784
13785show acl [<acl>]
13786 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013787 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13788 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13789 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13790 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13791 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013792
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013793show pools
13794 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13795 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13796 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13797 the pools.
13798
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013799show sess
13800 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013801 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13802 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13803
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013804show sess <id>
13805 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13806 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13807 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13808 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13809 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Oliviere99d44d2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020013810 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
13811 returned in src/dumpstats.c
13812
13813 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
13814 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013815
13816show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13817 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13818 possible to dump only selected items :
13819 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13820 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13821 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13822 for example:
13823 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13824 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13825 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13826
13827 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013828 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13829 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013830 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13831 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13832 Nbproc: 1
13833 Process_num: 1
13834 (...)
13835
13836 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13837 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13838 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13839 (...)
13840 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13841
13842 $
13843
13844 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13845 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13846 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13847 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013848 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013849
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013850show table
13851 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13852 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13853 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13854 entries currently in use.
13855
13856 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013857 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013858 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13859 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013860
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013861show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013862 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13863 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13864 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013865 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13866
13867 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13868 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13869 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13870 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13871 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13872
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013873 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13874 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13875 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13876 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13877 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13878 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13879
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013880
13881 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013882 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13883 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013884
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013885 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013886 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013887 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013888 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13889 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13890 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13891 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013892
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013893 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013894 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013895 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13896 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013897
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013898 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13899 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013900 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013901 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13902 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013903
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013904 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13905 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013906 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013907 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13908 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13909
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013910 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13911 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13912 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13913 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13914 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13915
13916 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13917 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13918 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013919 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13920 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013921 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13922 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013923
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013924shutdown frontend <frontend>
13925 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13926 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13927 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13928 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13929 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13930 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13931 once it is terminated.
13932
13933 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13934 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13935
13936 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13937 level "admin".
13938
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013939shutdown session <id>
13940 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13941 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13942 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13943 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13944 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13945 flag in the logs.
13946
Cyril Bontéde9789b2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020013947shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013948 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13949 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13950 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13951 'K' flag in the logs.
13952
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013953/*
13954 * Local variables:
13955 * fill-column: 79
13956 * End:
13957 */